blob: ae3023e52b8c3c3de3b68cb980f3c49198e8af40 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100458 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200459 - node
460 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100461 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100462
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 * Performance tuning
464 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200465 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100466 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100467 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100468 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200469 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200470 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200471 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 - noepoll
473 - nokqueue
474 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100475 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200476 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200477 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200478 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100479 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100480 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200481 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100482 - tune.maxaccept
483 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200484 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200485 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100486 - tune.rcvbuf.client
487 - tune.rcvbuf.server
488 - tune.sndbuf.client
489 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100490 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100491 - tune.ssl.lifetime
492 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100493 - tune.zlib.memlevel
494 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100495
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496 * Debugging
497 - debug
498 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499
500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502------------------------------------
503
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200504ca-base <dir>
505 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200506 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
507 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509chroot <jail dir>
510 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
511 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
512 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
513 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
514 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
515 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100516
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100517cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
518 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
519 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
520 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
521 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
522 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
523 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
524 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
525 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
526 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
527 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
528 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
529 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
530 they overlap.
531
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200532crt-base <dir>
533 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
534 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
535 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537daemon
538 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
539 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
540 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
541
542gid <number>
543 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
544 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
545 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100546 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
547 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550group <group name>
551 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
552 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100553
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200554log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
556 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100557 configured with "log global".
558
559 <address> can be one of:
560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100561 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100562 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
563 port).
564
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100565 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
566 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
567 port).
568
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
570 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
571 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
572 writeable).
573
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100574 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
575 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
576 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
577 in Bourne shell.
578
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100579 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580
581 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
582 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
583 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
584
585 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200586 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
587 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
588 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
589 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
590 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
591 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200593 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100595log-send-hostname [<string>]
596 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
597 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
598 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
599 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
600 the logs.
601
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000602log-tag <string>
603 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
604 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
605 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
606 running on the same host.
607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608nbproc <number>
609 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
610 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
611 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
612 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
613 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
614
615pidfile <pidfile>
616 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
617 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
618 starting the process. See also "daemon".
619
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100620stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200621 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
622 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
623 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
624 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
625 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
626 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
627 the number of processes used.
628
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629ssl-server-verify [none|required]
630 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
631 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
632 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
633
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200634stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
635 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
636 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
637 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
638 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200639
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200640 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
641 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
642 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200643
644stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
645 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
646 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100647 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200648
649stats maxconn <connections>
650 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
651 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
652
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653uid <number>
654 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
655 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
656 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
657 one. See also "gid" and "user".
658
659ulimit-n <number>
660 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
661 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
662 option.
663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100664unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
665 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
666
667 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
668 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
669 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
670 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
671 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
672 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
673 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
674 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
675 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
676 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678user <user name>
679 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
680 See also "uid" and "group".
681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200682node <name>
683 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
684
685 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
686 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
687 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
688 traffic.
689
690description <text>
691 Add a text that describes the instance.
692
693 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
694 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
695 "<" and ">" characters.
696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006983.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699-----------------------
700
701maxconn <number>
702 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
703 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
704 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
705 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
706
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200707maxconnrate <number>
708 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
709 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
710 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
711 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
712 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
713 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
714 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
715 fairness.
716
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100717maxcomprate <number>
718 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
719 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
720 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
721 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
722 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
723 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
724 default value.
725
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100726maxcompcpuusage <number>
727 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
728 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
729 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
730 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
731 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
732 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
733 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
734 process down and from introducing high latencies.
735
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100736maxpipes <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
738 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
739 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
740 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
741 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
742 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
743
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200744maxsessrate <number>
745 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
746 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
747 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
748 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
749 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
750 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
751 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
752 fairness.
753
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200754maxsslconn <number>
755 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
756 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
757 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
758 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
759 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
760 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
761 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
762
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200763maxsslrate <number>
764 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
765 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
766 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
767 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
768 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
769 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
770 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
771 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
772 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
773 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
774
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100775maxzlibmem <number>
776 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
777 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
778 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100779 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
780 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
781 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
782
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783noepoll
784 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
785 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100786 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787
788nokqueue
789 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
790 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
791 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
792
793nopoll
794 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
795 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100796 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100797 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100799nosplice
800 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
801 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
802 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100803 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100804 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
805 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
806 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
807 "option splice-response".
808
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200809spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900810 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
811 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
812 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
813 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
814 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
815 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200817tune.bufsize <number>
818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400826 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
827 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
828 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200829
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200830tune.chksize <number>
831 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
832 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
833 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
834 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
835 checks whenever possible.
836
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100837tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
838 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
839 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
840 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
841 this value. The default value is 1.
842
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100843tune.http.cookielen <number>
844 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
845 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
846 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
847 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
848 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
849 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
850 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
851 to change this value.
852
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200853tune.http.maxhdr <number>
854 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
855 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
856 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
857 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
858 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
859 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
860 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
861 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
862 limit too high.
863
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100864tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100865 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
866 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
867 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
868 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
869 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
870 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
871 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
872 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
873 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
874 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100875
876tune.maxpollevents <number>
877 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
878 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
879 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
880 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
881 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
882
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200883tune.maxrewrite <number>
884 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
885 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
886 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
887 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
888 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
889 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
890 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
891 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
892 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
893 bufsize.
894
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200895tune.pipesize <number>
896 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
897 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
898 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
899 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
900 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
901 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
902
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100903tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
904tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
905 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
906 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
907 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
908 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
909 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
910 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
911 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
912
913tune.sndbuf.client <number>
914tune.sndbuf.server <number>
915 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
916 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
917 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
918 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
919 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
920 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
921 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
922 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
923 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
924 notifying haproxy again.
925
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100926tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100927 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
928 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
929 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
930 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
931 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
932 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
933 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
934 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
935 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100936 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
937 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100938
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100939tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
940 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
941 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
942 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
943 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
944 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
945 being used for too long.
946
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100947tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
948 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
949 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
950 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
951 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
952 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
953 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
954 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
955 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
956 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
957 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
958 best value.
959
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100960tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
961 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
962 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
963 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
964 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
965 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
966
967tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
968 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
969 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
970 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
971 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733.3. Debugging
974--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975
976debug
977 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
978 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
979 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
980 system startup.
981
982quiet
983 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
984 line argument "-q".
985
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009873.4. Userlists
988--------------
989It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
990http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
991it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
992
993userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100994 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100995 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
996
997group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100998 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100999 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1000 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1001
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001002user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1003 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001004 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1005 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001006 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1007 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001008 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
1009 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
1010
1011
1012 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001013 userlist L1
1014 group G1 users tiger,scott
1015 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001016
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001017 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1018 user scott insecure-password elgato
1019 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001020
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001021 userlist L2
1022 group G1
1023 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001024
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001025 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1026 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1027 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001028
1029 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001031
10323.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001033----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001034It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1035haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1036pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1037identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1038or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1039Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1040known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1041the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1042process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1043during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1044tables.
1045
1046peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001047 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001048 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1049
1050peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1051 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1052 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1053 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1054 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1055 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1056 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1057
1058 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1059 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1060
1061 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1062 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1063 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1064 across all peers.
1065
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001066 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1067 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1068 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1069
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001070 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001071 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001072 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1073 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1074 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001075
1076 backend mybackend
1077 mode tcp
1078 balance roundrobin
1079 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1080 stick on src
1081
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001082 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1083 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001084
1085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010864. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001088
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1090 - defaults <name>
1091 - frontend <name>
1092 - backend <name>
1093 - listen <name>
1094
1095A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1096its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1097section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099
1100A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1101connections.
1102
1103A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1104to forward incoming connections.
1105
1106A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1107parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1110'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1111case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1112
1113Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1114logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1115proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1116However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1117name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1118
1119Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1120and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001121bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001122protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1123modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1124arbitrary criteria.
1125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011274.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1128--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001130The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1131limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1132they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1133limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001135option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001136and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1137with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1138specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001140
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001141 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1142------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1143acl - X X X
1144appsession - - X X
1145backlog X X X -
1146balance X - X X
1147bind - X X -
1148bind-process X X X X
1149block - X X X
1150capture cookie - X X -
1151capture request header - X X -
1152capture response header - X X -
1153clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001154compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001155contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1156cookie X - X X
1157default-server X - X X
1158default_backend X X X -
1159description - X X X
1160disabled X X X X
1161dispatch - - X X
1162enabled X X X X
1163errorfile X X X X
1164errorloc X X X X
1165errorloc302 X X X X
1166-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1167errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001168force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169fullconn X - X X
1170grace X X X X
1171hash-type X - X X
1172http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001173http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001174http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001175http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001176http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001177tcp-check expect - - X X
1178tcp-check send - - X X
1179tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001180http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001181id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001182ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001183log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001184maxconn X X X -
1185mode X X X X
1186monitor fail - X X -
1187monitor-net X X X -
1188monitor-uri X X X -
1189option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1190option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1191option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1192option allbackups (*) X - X X
1193option checkcache (*) X - X X
1194option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1195option contstats (*) X X X -
1196option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1197option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1198option forceclose (*) X X X X
1199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1200option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001201option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001202option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001203option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001204option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001205option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001206option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1207option httpchk X - X X
1208option httpclose (*) X X X X
1209option httplog X X X X
1210option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001211option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001212option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001213option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1214option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1215option logasap (*) X X X -
1216option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001217option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001218option nolinger (*) X X X X
1219option originalto X X X X
1220option persist (*) X - X X
1221option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001222option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001223option smtpchk X - X X
1224option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1225option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1226option splice-request (*) X X X X
1227option splice-response (*) X X X X
1228option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1229option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1230-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001231option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001232option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1233option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1234option tcpka X X X X
1235option tcplog X X X X
1236option transparent (*) X - X X
1237persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1238rate-limit sessions X X X -
1239redirect - X X X
1240redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1241redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1242reqadd - X X X
1243reqallow - X X X
1244reqdel - X X X
1245reqdeny - X X X
1246reqiallow - X X X
1247reqidel - X X X
1248reqideny - X X X
1249reqipass - X X X
1250reqirep - X X X
1251reqisetbe - X X X
1252reqitarpit - X X X
1253reqpass - X X X
1254reqrep - X X X
1255-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1256reqsetbe - X X X
1257reqtarpit - X X X
1258retries X - X X
1259rspadd - X X X
1260rspdel - X X X
1261rspdeny - X X X
1262rspidel - X X X
1263rspideny - X X X
1264rspirep - X X X
1265rsprep - X X X
1266server - - X X
1267source X - X X
1268srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001269stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001270stats auth X - X X
1271stats enable X - X X
1272stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001273stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001274stats realm X - X X
1275stats refresh X - X X
1276stats scope X - X X
1277stats show-desc X - X X
1278stats show-legends X - X X
1279stats show-node X - X X
1280stats uri X - X X
1281-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1282stick match - - X X
1283stick on - - X X
1284stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001285stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001287tcp-request connection - X X -
1288tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001289tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001290tcp-response content - - X X
1291tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292timeout check X - X X
1293timeout client X X X -
1294timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1295timeout connect X - X X
1296timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1297timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1298timeout http-request X X X X
1299timeout queue X - X X
1300timeout server X - X X
1301timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1302timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001303timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001304transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001305unique-id-format X X X -
1306unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001307use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001308use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1310 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013134.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1314---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001315
1316This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1317
1318
1319acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1320 Declare or complete an access list.
1321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1322 no | yes | yes | yes
1323 Example:
1324 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1325 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1326 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001328 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001329
1330
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001331appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1332 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001333 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1335 no | no | yes | yes
1336 Arguments :
1337 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1338 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1339
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001340 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 checked in each cookie value.
1342
1343 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1344 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1345 milliseconds.
1346
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001347 request-learn
1348 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1349 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1350 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1351 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1352 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1353 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1354
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001355 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1356 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1357 data following this prefix.
1358
1359 Example :
1360 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1361
1362 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1363 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1364
1365 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1366 2 modes are currently supported :
1367 - path-parameters :
1368 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1369 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1370 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1371 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1372 - query-string :
1373 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1374 query string.
1375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1377 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1378 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1379 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001380 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1381 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1382 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001383 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1384 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1385
1386 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1387
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001388 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1389 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1390 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001392 Example :
1393 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1394
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001395 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1396 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001397
1398
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001399backlog <conns>
1400 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1402 yes | yes | yes | no
1403 Arguments :
1404 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1405 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001406 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001407
1408 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1409 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1410 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1411 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1412 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1413 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1414 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1415 backlog parameter.
1416
1417 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1418 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1419 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1420
1421 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1422
1423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001425balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1428 yes | no | yes | yes
1429 Arguments :
1430 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1431 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1432 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1433 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1434
1435 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1436 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1437 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1438 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001439 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001440 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001441 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1442 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1443 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1444 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1445 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1446 it, so that you don't worry.
1447
1448 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1449 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1450 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1451 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1452 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1453 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1454 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1455 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001457 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1458 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1459 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1460 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1461 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1462 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1463 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1464 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1465
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001466 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1467 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1468 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1469 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001470 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001471 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1472 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1473 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1474 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1475 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001476 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1477 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1478 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1479 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1480 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1481 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1484 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1485 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1486 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1487 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1488 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1489 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1490 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001491 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001493 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1494 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1495 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001496
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001497 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1498 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1499 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1500 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1501 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1502 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1503 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1504 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1505 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1506 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1507 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1508 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001509
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001510 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001511 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1512 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1513 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1514 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1515 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1516 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1517 URIs start with a leading "/".
1518
1519 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1520 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1521 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1522 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001525 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1526
1527 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001528 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1529 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1530 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1531 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1532 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1533 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1534 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1535 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1536 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1537 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1538 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1539 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1540 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1541 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1542 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1543 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1544 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1545 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1546 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001547
1548 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1549 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1550 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1551 server will receive the request.
1552
1553 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1554 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1555 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1556 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1557 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001558 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1559 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1560 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001562 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1563 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1564 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1565 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1566 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001568 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001569 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1570 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1571 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1572
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001573 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1574 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1575 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1576
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001577 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001578 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001579 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1580 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1581 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1582 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1583 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1584 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001586 used instead.
1587
1588 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1589 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1590 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1591 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1592
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001593 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1594 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1595 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1596
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001597 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001600 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1601 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001602
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001603 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001604 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001606 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1607 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1608 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001609
1610 Examples :
1611 balance roundrobin
1612 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001613 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001614 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1615 balance hdr(host)
1616 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001617
1618 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1619 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001621 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001622 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1623 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1624 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1625 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1626
1627 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1628 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1629 defaults to 16 kB.
1630
1631 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1632 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1633
1634 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1635 Round Robin.
1636
1637 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1638 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1639 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1640 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1641
1642 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1643
1644 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001645 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001646 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1647 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1648 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001649
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001650 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1651 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001652
1653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001654bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1655bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1658 no | yes | yes | no
1659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001660 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1661 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1662 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1663 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001664 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001665 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1666 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1667 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1668 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1669 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1670 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1671 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001672 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1673 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1674 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001675 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1676 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1677 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1678 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001679
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001680 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1681 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001682 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1683 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1684 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001685 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1686 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1687 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1688 the range.
1689
1690 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1691 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1692 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1693 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1694 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1695 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1696 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001697 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001698 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001699
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001700 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1701 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1702 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1703 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1704 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1705 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1706 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1707 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1708
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001709 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1710 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1711 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1712 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001714 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1715 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1716 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1717 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1718 in a frontend.
1719
1720 Example :
1721 listen http_proxy
1722 bind :80,:443
1723 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001724 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001726 listen http_https_proxy
1727 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001728 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001729
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001730 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1731 bind ipv6@:80
1732 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1733 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1734
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001735 listen external_bind_app1
1736 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1737
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001738 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001739 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001742bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001743 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1745 yes | yes | yes | yes
1746 Arguments :
1747 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1748 may be used to override a default value.
1749
1750 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1751 option may be combined with other numbers.
1752
1753 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1754 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1755 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1756 missing from all processes.
1757
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001758 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1759 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1760 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1761 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1762 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001763
1764 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1765 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1766 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1767 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1768 and 'even' instances.
1769
1770 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1771 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1772 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1773 32.
1774
1775 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1776 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1777
1778 Example :
1779 listen app_ip1
1780 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001781 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001782
1783 listen app_ip2
1784 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001785 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001786
1787 listen management
1788 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001789 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001790
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001791 listen management
1792 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1793 bind-process 1-4
1794
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001795 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1796
1797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798block { if | unless } <condition>
1799 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1801 no | yes | yes | yes
1802
1803 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1804 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001805 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001806 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1808 "block" statements per instance.
1809
1810 Example:
1811 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1812 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1813 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1814 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001816 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817
1818
1819capture cookie <name> len <length>
1820 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1822 no | yes | yes | no
1823 Arguments :
1824 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1825 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1826 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1827 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1828 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1829
1830 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1831 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1832 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1833 right if it exceeds <length>.
1834
1835 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1836 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1837 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1838 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1839
1840 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1841 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1842 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1843
1844 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1845 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1846 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001847 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1848 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1849 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850
1851 Example:
1852 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1853
1854 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001855 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856
1857
1858capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001859 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1861 no | yes | yes | no
1862 Arguments :
1863 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001864 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1866 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1867 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1868
1869 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1870 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1871 it exceeds <length>.
1872
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001873 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1875 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001876 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1877 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1878 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1879 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001880 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001881 environments to find where the request came from.
1882
1883 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1884 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1885 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1886 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001888 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1889 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1890 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1891 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1892 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893
1894 Example:
1895 capture request header Host len 15
1896 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1897 capture request header Referrer len 15
1898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001899 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001900 about logging.
1901
1902
1903capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001904 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1906 no | yes | yes | no
1907 Arguments :
1908 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001909 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1911 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1912 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1913
1914 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1915 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1916 it exceeds <length>.
1917
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001918 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1920 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1921 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001922 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1923 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1924 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1925 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001926
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001927 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1928 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1929 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1930 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1931 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933 Example:
1934 capture response header Content-length len 9
1935 capture response header Location len 15
1936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001937 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938 about logging.
1939
1940
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001941clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1944 yes | yes | yes | no
1945 Arguments :
1946 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1948 as explained at the top of this document.
1949
1950 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1951 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1952 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1953 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1954 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1955 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1956 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1957 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001958 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1960 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1961
1962 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1963 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1964 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1965 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1966 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1967 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1968
1969 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1970 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1971
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001972 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1973 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001975compression algo <algorithm> ...
1976compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001977compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001978 Enable HTTP compression.
1979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1980 yes | yes | yes | yes
1981 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001982 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1983 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1984 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1985
1986 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001987 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001988 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1989 data.
1990
1991 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1992 support for zlib was built in.
1993
1994 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1995 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1996 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1997 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1998 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1999 in.
2000
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002001 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002002 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002003 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2004 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2005 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2006 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2007 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002008
2009 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2010 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2011 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2012 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2013 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002014 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2015 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2016 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2017 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2018 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2019 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002020
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002021 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002022 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2023 "Accept-Encoding" header
2024 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002025 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002026 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2027 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002028 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2029 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2030 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2031 "multipart"
2032 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2033 header
2034 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2035 and later
2036 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2037 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002038
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002039 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2040 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002041
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002042 Examples :
2043 compression algo gzip
2044 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002046contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2049 yes | no | yes | yes
2050 Arguments :
2051 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2053 as explained at the top of this document.
2054
2055 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002056 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002057 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2059 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2060 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2061 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2062
2063 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2064 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2065 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2066 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2067 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2068 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2069
2070 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2071 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2072 instead.
2073
2074 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2075 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2076
2077
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002078cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002079 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2080 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2083 yes | no | yes | yes
2084 Arguments :
2085 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2086 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2087 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2088 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2089 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2090 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2091 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2092 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2093 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2094
2095 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2096 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2097 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2098 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2099 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2100 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2101 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2102 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2103 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2104 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2105 "insert" and "prefix".
2106
2107 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002108 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002109
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002110 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002111 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2112 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2113 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2114 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2115 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2116 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2117 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2118 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2119 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2120 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121
2122 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2123 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2124 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2125 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2126 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2127 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2128 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2129 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2130 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2131 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002132 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2133 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2134 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002136 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2137 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2138 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002139 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2140 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2141 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2142 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002143 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2144 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2145 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
2147 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2148 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2149 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2150 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2151 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2152 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2153 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2154 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2155 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2156
2157 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2158 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2159 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2160 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2161 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2162 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2163 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2164 persistence cookie in the cache.
2165 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2166
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002167 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2168 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2169 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2170 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2171 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2172 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2173 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2174 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2175 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2176 they logout.
2177
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002178 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2179 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2180 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2181 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2182
2183 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2184 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2185 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2186 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2187 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2188 this attribute.
2189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002190 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002191 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002192 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2193 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2194 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2195 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2196 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2197 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002198
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002199 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2200 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2201 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2202 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2203 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2204 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2205 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2206 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2207 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2208 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2209 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2210 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2211 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2212 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2213 the site.
2214
2215 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2216 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2217 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2218 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2219 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2220 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2221 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2222 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2223 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2224 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2225 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2226 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2227 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2228 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2229 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2230 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2233 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2234 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2235 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Examples :
2238 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2239 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2240 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002241 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002243 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002244 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002247default-server [param*]
2248 Change default options for a server in a backend
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2250 yes | no | yes | yes
2251 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002252 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2253 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2254 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2255 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002256
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002257 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002258 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2259
2260 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263default_backend <backend>
2264 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2266 yes | yes | yes | no
2267 Arguments :
2268 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2269
2270 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2271 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2272 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2273 will catch all undetermined requests.
2274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002275 Example :
2276
2277 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2278 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2279 default_backend dynamic
2280
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002281 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002284description <string>
2285 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2287 no | yes | yes | yes
2288 Arguments : string
2289
2290 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2291 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2292 it describes.
2293 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2294
2295
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296disabled
2297 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2299 yes | yes | yes | yes
2300 Arguments : none
2301
2302 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2303 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2304 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2305 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2306 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2307 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2308 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2309
2310 See also : "enabled"
2311
2312
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002313dispatch <address>:<port>
2314 Set a default server address
2315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2316 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002317 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002318
2319 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2320 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2321 during start-up.
2322
2323 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2324 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2325 possible with normal servers.
2326
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002327 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002328 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2329 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2330 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2331 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2332
2333 See also : "server"
2334
2335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336enabled
2337 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2339 yes | yes | yes | yes
2340 Arguments : none
2341
2342 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2343 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2344
2345 See also : "disabled"
2346
2347
2348errorfile <code> <file>
2349 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2351 yes | yes | yes | yes
2352 Arguments :
2353 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002354 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002355
2356 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002357 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002359 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2360 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
2362 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2363 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2364 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2365
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002366 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2369 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2370 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2371 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2372
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002373 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2374 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2375 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2376 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2377 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2378 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2381 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2382 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002383 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2385
2386 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2387
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002388 Example :
2389 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2390 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2391 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2392
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002393
2394errorloc <code> <url>
2395errorloc302 <code> <url>
2396 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 yes | yes | yes | yes
2399 Arguments :
2400 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002401 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002402
2403 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2404 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2405 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2406 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2407 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2408
2409 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2410 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2411 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2412
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002413 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002415 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2416 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2417 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2418 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2419 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2420 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2421 request.
2422
2423 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2424
2425
2426errorloc303 <code> <url>
2427 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 yes | yes | yes | yes
2430 Arguments :
2431 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2432 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2433
2434 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2435 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2436 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2437 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2438 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2439
2440 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2441 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2442 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2443
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002444 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002446 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2447 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2448 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2449 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002450 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002451
2452 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2453
2454
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002455force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2456 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2458 no | yes | yes | yes
2459
2460 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2461 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2462 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2463 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2464 marked down for maintenance operations.
2465
2466 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2467 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2468 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2469 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2470 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2471 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2472 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2473 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2474 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2475
2476 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2477 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2478 is used.
2479
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002480 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002481 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002482
2483
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484fullconn <conns>
2485 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 yes | no | yes | yes
2488 Arguments :
2489 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2490 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2491
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002492 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002493 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002494 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002495 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2496 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2497 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2498 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2499 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002500 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002501
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002502 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2503 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2504 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002506 Example :
2507 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2508 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2509 # connections.
2510 backend dynamic
2511 fullconn 10000
2512 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2513 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2514
2515 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2516
2517
2518grace <time>
2519 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002521 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522 Arguments :
2523 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2524 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2525 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2526
2527 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2528 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002529 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002530 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2531
2532 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2533 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2534 simplify it.
2535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002537hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002538 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 yes | no | yes | yes
2541 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002542 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2543 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002544
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002545 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2546 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2547 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2548 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2549 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2550 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2551 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2552 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2553 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2554 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002555
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002556 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2557 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2558 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2559 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2560 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2561 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2562 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2563 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2564 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2565 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2566 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2567 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2568 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002569 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2570 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002571
2572 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2573
2574 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2575 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2576 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2577 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002578 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2579 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2580 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002581
2582 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2583 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002584 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2585 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2586 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2587 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2588
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002589 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2590 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2591 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2592 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2593 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2594 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2595 parameter.
2596
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002597 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2598
2599 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2600 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2601 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2602 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2603 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2604 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2605 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2606 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2607 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2608 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2609 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2610 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002611
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002612 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2613 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2614 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002615
2616 See also : "balance", "server"
2617
2618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619http-check disable-on-404
2620 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623 Arguments : none
2624
2625 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2626 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2627 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2628 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2629 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2630 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2631 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2632 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002633 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2634 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2635 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2636
2637 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2638
2639
2640http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002641 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002643 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002644 Arguments :
2645 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2646 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002647 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002648 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2649 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2650 details on the supported keywords.
2651
2652 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2653 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2654 with the usual backslash ('\').
2655
2656 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2657 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2658 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2659 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2660 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2661
2662 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002663 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002664 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2665 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2666 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2667
2668 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002670 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2671 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2672 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2673 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2674
2675 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002676 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002677 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2678 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2679 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2680 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2681 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2682 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2683 trace).
2684
2685 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002686 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002687 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2688 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2689 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2690 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2691 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2692 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2693
2694 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2695 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2696 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2697 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2698 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2699 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2700 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2701 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2702
2703 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2704 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2705
2706 Examples :
2707 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002708 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002709
2710 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002711 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002712
2713 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002714 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002715
2716 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002717 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002719 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720
2721
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002722http-check send-state
2723 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2725 yes | no | yes | yes
2726 Arguments : none
2727
2728 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2729 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2730 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2731 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2732 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2733
2734 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2735 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2736 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2737 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2738 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2739 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2740 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2741 checked in multiple backends.
2742
2743 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2744 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2745
2746 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2747 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2748 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2749 one fails.
2750
2751 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2752 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2753 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2754
2755 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2756 server's queue.
2757
2758 Example of a header received by the application server :
2759 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2760 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2761
2762 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2763
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002764http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002765 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002766 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2767 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002768 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002769 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2770
2771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 no | yes | yes | yes
2773
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002774 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2775 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2776 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2777 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2778 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002779
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002780 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2781 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2782 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2783
2784 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2785 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2786 are evaluated.
2787
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002788 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2789 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2790 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2791 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2792 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2793 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2794 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2795 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2796 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2797 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2798 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2799
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002800 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2801 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2802 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2803 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2804 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2805
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002806 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2807 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2808 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002809 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2810 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002811
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002812 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2813 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2814 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2815 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2816 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2817 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2818 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2819 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2820
2821 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2822 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2823 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2824 external users.
2825
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002826 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2827 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2828 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2829 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2830 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2831 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2832 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2833 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2834
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002835 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2836 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2837 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2838 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2839 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2840 another equipment.
2841
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002842 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2843 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2844 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2845 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2846 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2847 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2848 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2849 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2850
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002851 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2852 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2853 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2854 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2855 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2856 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2857 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2858 admin privileges.
2859
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002860 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2861
2862 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2863 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2864 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2865 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002866
2867 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002868 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2869 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2870 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002871
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002872 http-request allow if nagios
2873 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2874 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2875 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002877 Example:
2878 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002879 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002880
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002881 Example:
2882 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2883 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2884 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2885 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2886 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2887 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2888 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2889 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2890 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2891
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002892 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2893 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002894
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002895http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002896 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002897 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2898 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002899 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2900
2901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2902 no | yes | yes | yes
2903
2904 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2905 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2906 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2907 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2908 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2909 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2910
2911 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2912 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2913 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2914 current section.
2915
2916 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2917 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2918 rules are evaluated.
2919
2920 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2921 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2922 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2923 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2924 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2925 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2926 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2927
2928 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2929 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2930 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2931 external users.
2932
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002933 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2934 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2935 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2936 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2937 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2938 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2939 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2940 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2941
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002942 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2943 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2944 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2945 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2946 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2947 another equipment.
2948
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002949 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2950 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2951 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2952 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2953 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2954 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2955 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2956 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2957
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002958 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2959 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2960 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2961 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2962 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2963 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2964 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2965 admin privileges.
2966
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002967 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2968
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002969 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002970 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2971 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2972 rules.
2973
2974 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2975 ACL usage.
2976
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002977
2978tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2979 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2981 no | no | yes | yes
2982
2983 Arguments :
2984 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2985 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2986 binary.
2987 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2988 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2989 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2990
2991 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2992 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2993 with the usual backslash ('\').
2994 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2995 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2996 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2997 used upper or lower case.
2998
2999
3000 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3001
3002 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3003 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3004 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3005 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3006 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3007 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3008 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3009 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3010
3011 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3012 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3013 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3014 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3015 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3016 expression.
3017
3018 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3019 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3020 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3021 this exact hexadecimal string.
3022 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3023
3024 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3025 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3026 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3027 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3028 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3029 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3030 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3031 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3032 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3033 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3034 the null character.
3035
3036 Examples :
3037 # perform a POP check
3038 option tcp-check
3039 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3040
3041 # perform an IMAP check
3042 option tcp-check
3043 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3044
3045 # look for the redis master server
3046 option tcp-check
3047 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3048 tcp-check expect +PONG
3049 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3050 tcp-check expect string role:master
3051 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3052 tcp-check expect string +OK
3053
3054
3055 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3056 tune.chksize
3057
3058
3059tcp-check send <data>
3060 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 no | no | yes | yes
3063
3064 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3065 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3066
3067 Examples :
3068 # look for the redis master server
3069 option tcp-check
3070 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3071 tcp-check expect string role:master
3072
3073 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3074 tune.chksize
3075
3076
3077tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3078 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3079 tcp health check
3080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 no | no | yes | yes
3082
3083 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3084 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3085 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3086 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3087 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3088 hexadecimal string.
3089 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3090
3091 Examples :
3092 # redis check in binary
3093 option tcp-check
3094 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3095 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3096
3097
3098 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3099 tune.chksize
3100
3101
3102
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003103http-send-name-header [<header>]
3104 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3105
3106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3107 yes | no | yes | yes
3108
3109 Arguments :
3110
3111 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3112
3113 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3114 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3115 is added with the header string proved.
3116
3117 See also : "server"
3118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003119id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003120 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 no | yes | yes | yes
3123 Arguments : none
3124
3125 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3126 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3127 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003128
3129
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003130ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3131 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3133 no | yes | yes | yes
3134
3135 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3136 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3137 and running).
3138
3139 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3140 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3141 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3142 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3143 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3144
3145 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3146 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3147
3148 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3149 "unless" condition is met.
3150
3151 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3152
3153
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003154log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003155log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003156no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003157 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003160
3161 Prefix :
3162 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3163 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3164 prefix does not allow arguments.
3165
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003166 Arguments :
3167 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3168 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3169 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3170 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3171 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3172 parameter.
3173
3174 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3175 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3176
3177 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3178 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3179 standard syslog port).
3180
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003181 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3182 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3183 standard syslog port).
3184
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003185 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3186 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3187 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3188 appropriately writeable).
3189
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003190 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3191 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3192 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3193 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3196
3197 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3198 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3199 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3200
3201 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3202 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3203 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003204 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3205 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3206 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3207 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3208 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003209
3210 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3211
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003212 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3213 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3214 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003215
3216 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3217 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3218 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3219 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3220
3221 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3222 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003223
3224 Example :
3225 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003226 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3227 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003228 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003231log-format <string>
3232 Allows you to custom a log line.
3233
3234 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003236
3237maxconn <conns>
3238 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | yes | yes | no
3241 Arguments :
3242 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3243 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3244 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3245 closes.
3246
3247 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3248 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3249 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3250 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3251 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3252 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3253 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3254 properly tuned.
3255
3256 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3257 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3258 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3259
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003260 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3263
3264
3265mode { tcp|http|health }
3266 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3268 yes | yes | yes | yes
3269 Arguments :
3270 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3271 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3272 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3273 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3274
3275 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3276 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3277 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3278 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3279 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3280
3281 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003282 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3283 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3284 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3285 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3286 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3287 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3288 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003289
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003290 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3291 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3292 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003293
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003294 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003295 defaults http_instances
3296 mode http
3297
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003298 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003301monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003302 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3304 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 Arguments :
3306 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3307 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003308 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3310 backend and its backup.
3311
3312 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3313 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3314 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3315 servers in a list of backends.
3316
3317 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3318 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3319 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3320 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3321 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3322 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3323 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003324 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3325 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326
3327 Example:
3328 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003330 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3331 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3332 monitor-uri /site_alive
3333 monitor fail if site_dead
3334
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003335 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003336
3337
3338monitor-net <source>
3339 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 yes | yes | yes | no
3342 Arguments :
3343 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3344 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3345 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3346 followed by a mask.
3347
3348 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3349 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003350 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003351 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3352
3353 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3354 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3355 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3356 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003357 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3358 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3359 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003361 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3362 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3363 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3364 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3365 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3366 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003367
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003368 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3369 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003370
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003371 Example :
3372 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3373 frontend www
3374 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3375
3376 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3377
3378
3379monitor-uri <uri>
3380 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3382 yes | yes | yes | no
3383 Arguments :
3384 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3385 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3386
3387 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3388 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3389 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3390 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3391 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3392 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3393 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3394 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3395
3396 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3397 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3398 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3399 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3400 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3401 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3402
3403 Example :
3404 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3405 frontend www
3406 mode http
3407 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3408
3409 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003412option abortonclose
3413no option abortonclose
3414 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3416 yes | no | yes | yes
3417 Arguments : none
3418
3419 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3420 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3421 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3422 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003423 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003424 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3425 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3426 encountered while delivering the response.
3427
3428 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3429 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3430 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3431 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3432 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3433 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003434 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003435 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003436 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003437 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3438 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3439 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3440
3441 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3442 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3443 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3444 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3445 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3446 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3447 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3448 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003449 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003450
3451 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3452 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3453
3454 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3455
3456
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003457option accept-invalid-http-request
3458no option accept-invalid-http-request
3459 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | yes | yes | no
3462 Arguments : none
3463
3464 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3465 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3466 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3467 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3468 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3469 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3470 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3471 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003472 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3473 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3474 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3475 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3476 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3477 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003478
3479 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3480 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3481 been confirmed.
3482
3483 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3484 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003485 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3486 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003487 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3488
3489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3491
3492 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3493 stats socket.
3494
3495
3496option accept-invalid-http-response
3497no option accept-invalid-http-response
3498 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3500 yes | no | yes | yes
3501 Arguments : none
3502
3503 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3504 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3505 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3506 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3507 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3508 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3509 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3510 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3511 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3512
3513 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3514 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3515 been confirmed.
3516
3517 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3518 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3519 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3520 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3521
3522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3524
3525 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3526 stats socket.
3527
3528
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003529option allbackups
3530no option allbackups
3531 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 yes | no | yes | yes
3534 Arguments : none
3535
3536 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3537 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3538 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3539 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3540 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3541 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3542 order between the backup servers anymore.
3543
3544 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3545 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3546
3547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3549
3550
3551option checkcache
3552no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003553 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 yes | no | yes | yes
3556 Arguments : none
3557
3558 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3559 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003560 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003561 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3562 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003563 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003564
3565 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003566 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003567 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003568 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3569 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003570 to the client are :
3571 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003572 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003573 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003574 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3575 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3576 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3577 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3578 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3579 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3580 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3581 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3582 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3583 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3584 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3585
3586 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003587 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003588 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003589 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003590 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3591
3592 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3593 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003594 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003595 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3596
3597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3599
3600
3601option clitcpka
3602no option clitcpka
3603 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | yes | yes | no
3606 Arguments : none
3607
3608 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3609 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3610 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3611 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3612
3613 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3614 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3615 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3616 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3617
3618 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3619 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3620 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3621 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3622 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3623
3624 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3625
3626 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3627 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3628 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3629
3630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3632
3633 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3634
3635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003636option contstats
3637 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 yes | yes | yes | no
3640 Arguments : none
3641
3642 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3643 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3644 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3645 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3646 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3647 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3648 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3649
3650
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003651option dontlog-normal
3652no option dontlog-normal
3653 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | yes | yes | no
3656 Arguments : none
3657
3658 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3659 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3660 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3661 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3662 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3663 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3664 logged.
3665
3666 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3667 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3668 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003670 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003671 logging.
3672
3673
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003674option dontlognull
3675no option dontlognull
3676 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | no
3679 Arguments : none
3680
3681 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3682 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3683 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3684 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3685 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3686 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3687 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3688
3689 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3690 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3691 would not be logged.
3692
3693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003696 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697
3698
3699option forceclose
3700no option forceclose
3701 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003704 Arguments : none
3705
3706 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3707 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3708 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3709 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3710 global session times in the logs.
3711
3712 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003713 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003714 to respond and release some resources earlier than with 'option httpclose'.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003715
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003716 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3717 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3718 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3719
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003720 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
3721 http-server-close' or 'option http-keep-alive'. When frontend and backend
3722 options differ, 'option forceclose' has precedence over all other options.
3723
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003724 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3725 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3726
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003727 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003728
3729
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003730option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003731 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | yes | yes | yes
3734 Arguments :
3735 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3736 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003737 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003738 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003739
3740 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3741 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3742 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3743 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3744 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3745 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3746 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003747 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3748 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3749 possible that the client has already brought one.
3750
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003751 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003752 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003753 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3754 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003755 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3756 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003757
3758 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3759 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3760 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3761 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3762 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3763 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3764 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3765
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003766 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3767 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3768 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3769 are under the control of the end-user.
3770
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003771 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003772 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3773 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003774 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3775 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3776 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003777
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003778 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3779 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3780 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3781 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3782 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003783
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003784 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003785 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3786 frontend www
3787 mode http
3788 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3789
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003790 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3791 backend www
3792 mode http
3793 option forwardfor header X-Client
3794
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003795 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3796 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003797
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003798
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003799option http-keep-alive
3800no option http-keep-alive
3801 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804 Arguments : none
3805
3806 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3807 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3808 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3809 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3810 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3811 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3812 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3813 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3814 situations where this option may be useful :
3815
3816 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3817 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3818
3819 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3820 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3821
3822 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3823 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3824 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3825 request.
3826
3827 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3828 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003829 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3830 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3831 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003832
3833 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3834 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3835
3836 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3837 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3838 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3839 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3840 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3841 not set.
3842
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003843 This option disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option
3844 http-server-close' or 'option forceclose'. When frontend and backend options
3845 differ, all of these 3 options have precedence over 'option http-keep-alive'.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003846
3847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3849
3850 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003851 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3852 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003853
3854
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003855option http-no-delay
3856no option http-no-delay
3857 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3859 yes | yes | yes | yes
3860 Arguments : none
3861
3862 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3863 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3864 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3865 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3866 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3867 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3868 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3869 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3870 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3871 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3872 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3873 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3874 affected.
3875
3876 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3877 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3878 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3879 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3880 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3881 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3882 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3883 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3884 latency environments.
3885
3886
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003887option http-pretend-keepalive
3888no option http-pretend-keepalive
3889 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | yes | yes | yes
3892 Arguments : none
3893
3894 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3895 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3896 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3897 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3898 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3899 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3900 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3901 consider the response complete.
3902
3903 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3904 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3905 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3906 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3907 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3908 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3909
3910 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3911 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3912 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3913 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3914 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3915 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3916 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3917
3918 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3919 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003920 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003921 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3922 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003923
3924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3926
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003927 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3928 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003929
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003930
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003931option http-server-close
3932no option http-server-close
3933 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3935 yes | yes | yes | yes
3936 Arguments : none
3937
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003938 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3939 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3940 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3941 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3942 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3943 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3944 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3945 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3946 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3947 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3948 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3949 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003950
3951 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3952 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3953 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3954 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003955 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3956 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003957
3958 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3959 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003960 It disables and replaces any previous 'option httpclose', 'option forceclose'
3961 or 'option http-keep-alive'. When frontend and backend options differ, both
3962 'option forceclose' and 'option httpclose' have precedence over
3963 'option http-server-close' and both result in the same setup as if only
3964 'option forceclose' was set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003965
3966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3968
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003969 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003970 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3971 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003972
3973
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003974option http-tunnel
3975no option http-tunnel
3976 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | yes | yes | yes
3979 Arguments : none
3980
3981 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3982 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Option
3983 "http-tunnel" just does this and cancels any other option among
3984 "option forceclose", "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive",
3985 and "option http-server-close". It is the mode with the lowest processing
3986 overhead, which is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific
3987 cases such as when using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is
3988 not compatible, or just to log one request per client in order to reduce
3989 log size.
3990
3991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3993
3994 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
3995 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3996 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
3997
3998
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003999option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004000no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004001 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | no
4004 Arguments : none
4005
4006 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4007 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4008 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4009 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4010 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4011 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4012 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4013
4014 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4015 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4016 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4017 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4018 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4019 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4020 request along its whole life.
4021
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004022 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4023 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4024 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4025 front of an existing proxy.
4026
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004027 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4028
4029 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4030 http-server-close".
4031
4032
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004033option httpchk
4034option httpchk <uri>
4035option httpchk <method> <uri>
4036option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4037 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | no | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4042 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4043 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4044 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4045 ones.
4046
4047 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4048 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4049 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4050
4051 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4052 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4053 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4054 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4055 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4056
4057 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4058 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4059 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4060 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4061 the lack of any response.
4062
4063 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4064
4065 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4066 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4067 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4068
4069 Examples :
4070 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4071 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4072 backend https_relay
4073 mode tcp
4074 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4075 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4076
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004077 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4078 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4079 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004080
4081
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004082option httpclose
4083no option httpclose
4084 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | yes | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004089 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4090 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4091 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4092 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4093 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4094 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4095 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004096
4097 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004098 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004099 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4100 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4101 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4102 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4103 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004104
4105 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4106 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004107 It disables and replaces any previous 'option http-server-close',
4108 'option forceclose' or 'option http-keep-alive'. When frontend and backend
4109 options differ, 'option httpclose' has precedence over all other options and
4110 results in the same setup as if only 'option forceclose' was set.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004111
4112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4114
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004115 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4116 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004117
4118
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004119option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004120 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004123 Arguments :
4124 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4125 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4126 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4127 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4128 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004129
4130 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4131 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4132 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4133 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4134 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4135 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4136 ports.
4137
4138 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4139
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4142 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4143 by default.
4144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004145 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004147
4148option http_proxy
4149no option http_proxy
4150 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | yes | yes | yes
4153 Arguments : none
4154
4155 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4156 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4157 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4158 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4159 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4160
4161 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4162 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4163 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4164 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004165 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004166 be analyzed.
4167
4168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4170
4171 Example :
4172 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4173 backend direct_forward
4174 option httpclose
4175 option http_proxy
4176
4177 See also : "option httpclose"
4178
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004179
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004180option independent-streams
4181no option independent-streams
4182 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4184 yes | yes | yes | yes
4185 Arguments : none
4186
4187 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4188 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4189 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4190 receive data or not.
4191
4192 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4193 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4194 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4195 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4196 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4197 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4198 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4199 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4200 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4201 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4202 socket buffers.
4203
4204 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4205 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4206 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4207 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4208 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4209
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004210 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4211 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4212 deprecated.
4213
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004214 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004215
4216
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004217option ldap-check
4218 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4220 yes | no | yes | yes
4221 Arguments : none
4222
4223 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4224 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4225 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4226 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4227
4228 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4229 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4230
4231 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4232 configure it.
4233
4234 Example :
4235 option ldap-check
4236
4237 See also : "option httpchk"
4238
4239
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004240option log-health-checks
4241no option log-health-checks
4242 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 yes | no | yes | yes
4245 Arguments : none
4246
4247 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4248 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4249 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4250 of additional information is limited.
4251
4252 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4253 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4254
4255 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4256
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004257
4258option log-separate-errors
4259no option log-separate-errors
4260 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 yes | yes | yes | no
4263 Arguments : none
4264
4265 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4266 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4267 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4268 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4269 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4270 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4271 provides very important information.
4272
4273 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4274 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4275 error logs.
4276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004277 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004278 logging.
4279
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004280
4281option logasap
4282no option logasap
4283 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4285 yes | yes | yes | no
4286 Arguments : none
4287
4288 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4289 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4290 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4291 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4292 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4293 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4294 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004295 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004296 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4297 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004299 Examples :
4300 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4301 mode http
4302 option httplog
4303 option logasap
4304 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4305
4306 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4307 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4308 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4309 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004311 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004312 logging.
4313
4314
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004315option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4316 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4318 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004319 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004320 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4321 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004322
4323 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4324 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4325 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4326 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4327 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4328 in the MySQL table, like this :
4329
4330 USE mysql;
4331 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4332 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4333
4334 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4335 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4336 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4337 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4338 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4339 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4340 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4341 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4342 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4343
4344 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4345 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004346
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004347 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004348
4349 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4350 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4351 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4352 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4353 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4354 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4355
4356 See also: "option httpchk"
4357
4358
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004359option nolinger
4360no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004361 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004362 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004364 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004365
4366 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4367 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4368 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4369 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4370 connections.
4371
4372 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4373 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4374 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4375 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4376 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4377 this too.
4378
4379 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4380 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4381 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4382
4383 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4384 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4385 for servers.
4386
4387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4389
4390
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004391option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4392 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | yes | yes | yes
4395 Arguments :
4396 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4397 matching <network>
4398 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4399 header name.
4400
4401 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4402 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4403 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4404 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4405 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4406 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4407 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4408 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4409 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4410 possible that the client has already brought one.
4411
4412 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4413 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4414 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4415 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4416 header and requires different one.
4417
4418 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4419 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4420 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4421 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4422 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4423 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4424 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4425
4426 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4427 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4428 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4429 both are defined.
4430
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004431 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4432 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4433 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4434 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4435 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004436
4437 Examples :
4438 # Original Destination address
4439 frontend www
4440 mode http
4441 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4442
4443 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4444 backend www
4445 mode http
4446 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4447
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004448 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4449 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004450
4451
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004452option persist
4453no option persist
4454 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4455 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4456 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004457 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004458
4459 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4460 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4461 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4462 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4463 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4464 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4465 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4466 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4467 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4468 redirected to another valid server.
4469
4470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4472
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004473 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004474
4475
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004476option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4477 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | no | yes | yes
4480 Arguments :
4481 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4482 PostgreSQL server.
4483
4484 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4485 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4486 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4487 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4488
4489 See also: "option httpchk"
4490
4491
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004492option prefer-last-server
4493no option prefer-last-server
4494 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 yes | no | yes | yes
4497 Arguments : none
4498
4499 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4500 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4501 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4502 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4503 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4504 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4505 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4506 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4507 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004508 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4509 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4510 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4511 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4512 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4513 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4514 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004515
4516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4518
4519 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4520
4521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004522option redispatch
4523no option redispatch
4524 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004527 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004528
4529 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4530 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4531 be able to access the service anymore.
4532
4533 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4534 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4535
4536 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4537 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4538 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004540 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4541 "redisp" keywords.
4542
4543 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4544 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4545
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004546 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004547
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004548
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004549option redis-check
4550 Use redis health checks for server testing
4551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | no | yes | yes
4553 Arguments : none
4554
4555 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4556 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4557 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4558 find the "+PONG" response message.
4559
4560 Example :
4561 option redis-check
4562
4563 See also : "option httpchk"
4564
4565
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004566option smtpchk
4567option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4568 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004572 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4573 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4574 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4575
4576 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4577 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4578 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4579
4580 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4581 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4582 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4583 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4584 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4585 dead server.
4586
4587 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4588 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4589 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4590 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4591
4592 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4593 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4594 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4595 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4596 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4597
4598 Example :
4599 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4600
4601 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004604option socket-stats
4605no option socket-stats
4606
4607 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | yes | yes | no
4610
4611 Arguments : none
4612
4613
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004614option splice-auto
4615no option splice-auto
4616 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | yes
4619 Arguments : none
4620
4621 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4622 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4623 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4624 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004625 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004626 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4627 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4628 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4629 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4630
4631 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4632 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4633 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4634 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4635 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4636 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4637 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4638 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4639 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4640 keyword.
4641
4642 Example :
4643 option splice-auto
4644
4645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4647
4648 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4649 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4650
4651
4652option splice-request
4653no option splice-request
4654 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | yes | yes | yes
4657 Arguments : none
4658
4659 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004660 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004661 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4662 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4663 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4664 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4665
4666 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4667
4668 Example :
4669 option splice-request
4670
4671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4673
4674 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4675 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4676
4677
4678option splice-response
4679no option splice-response
4680 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 yes | yes | yes | yes
4683 Arguments : none
4684
4685 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004686 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004687 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4688 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4689 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4690 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4691
4692 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4693
4694 Example :
4695 option splice-response
4696
4697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4699
4700 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4701 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4702
4703
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004704option srvtcpka
4705no option srvtcpka
4706 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | no | yes | yes
4709 Arguments : none
4710
4711 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4712 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4713 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4714 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4715
4716 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4717 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4718 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4719 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4720
4721 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4722 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4723 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4724 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4725 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4726
4727 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4728
4729 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4730 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4731 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4732
4733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4735
4736 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4737
4738
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004739option ssl-hello-chk
4740 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | no | yes | yes
4743 Arguments : none
4744
4745 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4746 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4747 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4748 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4749 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4750 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4751 hello message.
4752
4753 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4754 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4755 messages, which is appreciable.
4756
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004757 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4758 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4759 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004760
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004761 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4762
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004763
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004764option tcp-check
4765 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4767 yes | no | yes | yes
4768
4769 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4770 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4771
4772 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4773 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4774 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4775
4776 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4777 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4778 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4779 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4780 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4781 only.
4782
4783 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4784 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4785 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4786 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4787 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4788
4789 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4790 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4791 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4792 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4793 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4794 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4795 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4796 the respective protocols.
4797 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4798 analysed.
4799
4800 Examples :
4801 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4802 option tcp-check
4803 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4804
4805 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4806 option tcp-check
4807 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4808
4809 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4810 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4811 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4812 option tcp-check
4813 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4814 tcp-check expect +PONG
4815 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4816 tcp-check expect string role:master
4817 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4818 tcp-check expect string +OK
4819
4820 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4821 (send many headers before analyzing)
4822 option tcp-check
4823 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4824 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4825 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4826 tcp-check send \r\n
4827 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4828
4829
4830 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4831
4832
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004833option tcp-smart-accept
4834no option tcp-smart-accept
4835 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | no
4838 Arguments : none
4839
4840 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4841 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4842 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4843 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4844 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4845 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4846
4847 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4848 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4849 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4850 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4851
4852 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4853 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4854 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4855 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4856
4857 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4858 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4859 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4860
4861 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4862 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4863 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4864
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004865 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4866
4867
4868option tcp-smart-connect
4869no option tcp-smart-connect
4870 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4872 yes | no | yes | yes
4873 Arguments : none
4874
4875 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4876 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4877 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4878 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4879 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4880
4881 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4882 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4883 complex.
4884
4885 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4886 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4887 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4888
4889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4891
4892 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4893
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004894
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004895option tcpka
4896 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | yes
4899 Arguments : none
4900
4901 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4902 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4903 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4904 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4905
4906 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4907 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4908 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4909 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4910
4911 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4912 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4913 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4914 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4915 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4916
4917 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4918
4919 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4920 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4921 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4922 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4923 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4924 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4925 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4926 backends.
4927
4928 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4929
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004930
4931option tcplog
4932 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935 Arguments : none
4936
4937 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4938 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4939 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4940 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4941 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4942 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4943 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4944 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4945
4946 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004948 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004949
4950
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004951option transparent
4952no option transparent
4953 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004956 Arguments : none
4957
4958 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4959 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4960 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4961 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4962 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4963 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4964 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4965 appropriate server.
4966
4967 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4968 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4969
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004970 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004971 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004973
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004974persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004975persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004976 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | no | yes | yes
4979 Arguments :
4980 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004981 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4982 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004983
4984 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4985 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4986 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4987 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4988 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4989 forwarded to this server.
4990
4991 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4992 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4993 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004994 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004995 a single "listen" section.
4996
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004997 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4998 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4999 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5000
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005001 Example :
5002 listen tse-farm
5003 bind :3389
5004 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5005 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5006 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5007 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5008 persist rdp-cookie
5009 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005010 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005011 balance rdp-cookie
5012 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5013 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5014
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005015 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5016 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005017
5018
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005019rate-limit sessions <rate>
5020 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | yes | yes | no
5023 Arguments :
5024 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5025 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5026
5027 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5028 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5029 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5030 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5031 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5032 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5033
5034 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5035 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5036 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5037 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5038
5039 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5040 listen smtp
5041 mode tcp
5042 bind :25
5043 rate-limit sessions 10
5044 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5045
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005046 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5047 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5048 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005049
5050 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5051
5052
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005053redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5054redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5055redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005056 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 no | yes | yes | yes
5059
5060 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005061 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005062
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005063 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005064 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005065 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5066 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5067 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005068
5069 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5070 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5071 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5072 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5073 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005074 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5075 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5076 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5077 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005078
5079 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5080 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5081 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5082 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5083 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5084 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5085 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5086 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005087 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5088 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5089 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005090
5091 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005092 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5093 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5094 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5095 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5096 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5097 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5098 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5099 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005100
5101 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5102 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5103
5104 - "drop-query"
5105 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5106 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5107 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5108 with a location-type redirect.
5109
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005110 - "append-slash"
5111 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5112 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5113 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5114 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5115
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005116 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5117 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5118 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5119 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5120 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5121 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5122 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5123
5124 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5125 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5126 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5127 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5128 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5129 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5130 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005131
5132 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5133 acl clear dst_port 80
5134 acl secure dst_port 8080
5135 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005136 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005137 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005138 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5139
5140 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005141 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5142 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5143 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005144 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005145
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005146 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5147 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5148 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5149
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005150 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005151 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005152
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005153 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5154 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5155 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005157 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005158
5159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005160redisp (deprecated)
5161redispatch (deprecated)
5162 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005165 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005166
5167 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5168 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5169 be able to access the service anymore.
5170
5171 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5172 redistribute them to a working server.
5173
5174 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5175 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5176 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005178 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5179 "option redispatch" instead.
5180
5181 See also : "option redispatch"
5182
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005183
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005184reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 no | yes | yes | yes
5188 Arguments :
5189 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5190 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005191 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005192
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005193 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5194 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5195
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005196 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5197 the last header of an HTTP request.
5198
5199 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5200 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5201 responses.
5202
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005203 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5204 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5205 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5206
5207 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5208 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005209
5210
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005211reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5212reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005213 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5215 no | yes | yes | yes
5216 Arguments :
5217 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5218 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5219 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5220 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5221 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5222 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5223 ignores case.
5224
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005225 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5226 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5227
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005228 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5229 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5230 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5231 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005232 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005233
5234 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5235 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5236
5237 Example :
5238 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5239 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5240 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005242 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5243 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005244
5245
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005246reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5247reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005248 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 no | yes | yes | yes
5251 Arguments :
5252 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5253 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5254 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5255 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5256 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5257 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005262 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5263 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5264 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5265 next servers.
5266
5267 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5268 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5269 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5270
5271 Example :
5272 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5273 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5274 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5275
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005276 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5277 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005278
5279
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005280reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5281reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005282 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5284 no | yes | yes | yes
5285 Arguments :
5286 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5287 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5288 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5289 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5290 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5291 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5292 case.
5293
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005294 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5295 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5296
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005297 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5298 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5299 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5300 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005301 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005302
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005303 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005304 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005305 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005306
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005307 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5308 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5309
5310 Example :
5311 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5312 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5313 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5314
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005315 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5316 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005317
5318
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005319reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5320reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005321 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5323 no | yes | yes | yes
5324 Arguments :
5325 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5326 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5327 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5328 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5329 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5330 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5331 case.
5332
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005333 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5334 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5335
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005336 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5337 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5338 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5339 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5340
5341 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5342 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5343
5344 Example :
5345 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5346 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5347 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5348 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5349
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005350 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5351 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005352
5353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005354reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5355reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005356 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 no | yes | yes | yes
5359 Arguments :
5360 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5361 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5362 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5363 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5364 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5365 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5366
5367 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5368 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5369 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5370 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005371 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005372
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005373 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5374 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5375
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5377 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5378 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5379
5380 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5381 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5382 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5383 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5384 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5385
5386 Example :
5387 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005388 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005389 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5390 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5391
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005392 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5393 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005394
5395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005396reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5397reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005398 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 no | yes | yes | yes
5401 Arguments :
5402 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5403 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5404 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5405 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5406 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5407 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5408 ignores case.
5409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005413 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5414 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005415 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5416 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5417 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005418 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5419 not set.
5420
5421 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5422 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5423 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5424 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5425 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5426
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005427 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005428 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5429 # block all others.
5430 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5431 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005433 # block bad guys
5434 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5435 reqitarpit . if badguys
5436
5437 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5438 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005439
5440
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005441retries <value>
5442 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | no | yes | yes
5445 Arguments :
5446 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5447 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5448 default value is 3.
5449
5450 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5451 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5452 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5453
5454 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5455 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5456
5457 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5458 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5459
5460 See also : "option redispatch"
5461
5462
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005463rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005464 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 no | yes | yes | yes
5467 Arguments :
5468 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5469 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005470 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005471
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005472 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5473 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5474
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005475 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5476 the last header of an HTTP response.
5477
5478 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5479 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5480 responses.
5481
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005482 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5483 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005484
5485
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005486rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5487rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005488 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 no | yes | yes | yes
5491 Arguments :
5492 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5493 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5494 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5495 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5496 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5497 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5498 ignores case.
5499
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005500 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5501 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5502
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005503 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5504 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005505 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005506 client.
5507
5508 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5509 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5510 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5511
5512 Example :
5513 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005514 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005515
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005516 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5517 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518
5519
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005520rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5521rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 no | yes | yes | yes
5525 Arguments :
5526 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5527 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5528 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5529 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5530 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5531 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5532 ignores case.
5533
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005534 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5535 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5536
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005537 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5538 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5539 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5540 case-sensitive.
5541
5542 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005543 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5544 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5545 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546
5547 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5548 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5549
5550 Example :
5551 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5552 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5553
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005554 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5555 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005556
5557
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005558rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5559rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005560 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 no | yes | yes | yes
5563 Arguments :
5564 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5565 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5566 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5567 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5568 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5569 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5570 ignores case.
5571
5572 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5573 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5574 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5575 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005576 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005577
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005578 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5579 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5580
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005581 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5582 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5583 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5584
5585 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5586 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5587 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5588 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5589 are not case-sensitive.
5590
5591 Example :
5592 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5593 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5594
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005595 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5596 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005597
5598
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005599server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005600 Declare a server in a backend
5601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5602 no | no | yes | yes
5603 Arguments :
5604 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005605 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005606 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005607
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005608 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5609 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5610 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5611 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005612 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5613 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5614 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5615 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5616 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005617 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5618 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5619 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5620 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5621 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5622 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5623 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005624 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5625 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5626 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5627 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005629 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005630 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5631 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5632 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5633 adding this value to the client's port.
5634
5635 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5636 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005637 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005638
5639 Examples :
5640 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5641 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005642 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005643 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5644 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5645 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005646
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005647 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5648 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005649
5650
5651source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005652source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005653source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005654 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
5657 Arguments :
5658 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5659 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005660
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005661 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005662 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5663 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5664 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5665 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5666 supported prefixes are :
5667 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5668 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5669 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005670 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5671 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5672 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5673 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005674
5675 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5676 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005677 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5678 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5679 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005680
5681 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5682 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5683 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5684 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5685 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5686 <addr>.
5687
5688 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5689 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5690 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5691 port.
5692
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005693 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5694 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5695 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5696 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005697 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005698 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5699 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5700 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5701 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5702 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5703 HTTP header.
5704
5705 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5706 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005707 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005708 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5709 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5710 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5711 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5712 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5713 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5714 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5715
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005716 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5717 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5718 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5719 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5720 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5721 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5722
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005723 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5724 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5725 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5726 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5727
5728 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5729 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5730 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5731 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5732 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5733 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5734
5735 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5736 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5737 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5738 there are two methods :
5739
5740 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5741 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5742 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5743 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5744 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5745 of the client ranges may be used.
5746
5747 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5748 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5749 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5750 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5751 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5752 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5753 same session.
5754
5755 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5756 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5757 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5758 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5759 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5760 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5761
5762 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5763 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5764 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005765 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005766
5767 Examples :
5768 backend private
5769 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5770 source 192.168.1.200
5771
5772 backend transparent_ssl1
5773 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5774 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5775
5776 backend transparent_ssl2
5777 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5778 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5779 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5780
5781 backend transparent_ssl3
5782 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5783 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5784 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5785
5786 backend transparent_smtp
5787 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5788 # with Tproxy version 4.
5789 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5790
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005791 backend transparent_http
5792 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5793 # proxy.
5794 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005796 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005797 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005800srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5801 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | no | yes | yes
5804 Arguments :
5805 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5806 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5807 as explained at the top of this document.
5808
5809 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5810 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5811 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5812 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5813 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5814 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5815 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5816
5817 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5818 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5819 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5820 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5821 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005822 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005823 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005824 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005825
5826 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5828 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5829 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5830 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5831 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5832
5833 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5834 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5835
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005836 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5837 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005838
5839
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005840stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5841 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5843 no | no | yes | yes
5844
5845 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5846 matched.
5847
5848 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5849 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5850
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005851 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5852 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5853 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5854
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005855 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5856 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5857 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5858 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005859
5860 Example :
5861 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5862 backend stats_localhost
5863 stats enable
5864 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5865
5866 Example :
5867 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5868 backend stats_auth
5869 stats enable
5870 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5871 stats admin if TRUE
5872
5873 Example :
5874 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5875 userlist stats-auth
5876 group admin users admin
5877 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5878 group readonly users haproxy
5879 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5880
5881 backend stats_auth
5882 stats enable
5883 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5884 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5885 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5886 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5887
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005888 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5889 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5890 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005891
5892
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005893stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5894 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | no | yes | yes
5897 Arguments :
5898 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5899
5900 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5901
5902 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5903 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5904 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5905 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5906 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5907 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5908
5909 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5910 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5911 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005912 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005913
5914 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5915 report using "stats scope".
5916
5917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5919 unobvious parameters.
5920
5921 Example :
5922 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5923 backend public_www
5924 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5925 stats enable
5926 stats hide-version
5927 stats scope .
5928 stats uri /admin?stats
5929 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5930 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5931 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5932
5933 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5934 backend private_monitoring
5935 stats enable
5936 stats uri /admin?stats
5937 stats refresh 5s
5938
5939 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5940
5941
5942stats enable
5943 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments : none
5947
5948 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5949 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5950 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5951 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5952 - stats auth : no authentication
5953 - stats scope : no restriction
5954
5955 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5956 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5957 unobvious parameters.
5958
5959 Example :
5960 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5961 backend public_www
5962 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5963 stats enable
5964 stats hide-version
5965 stats scope .
5966 stats uri /admin?stats
5967 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5968 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5969 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5970
5971 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5972 backend private_monitoring
5973 stats enable
5974 stats uri /admin?stats
5975 stats refresh 5s
5976
5977 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5978
5979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005980stats hide-version
5981 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005984 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005986 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5987 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5988 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5989 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5990 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5991 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005993 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5994 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5995 unobvious parameters.
5996
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005997 Example :
5998 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5999 backend public_www
6000 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006001 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006002 stats hide-version
6003 stats scope .
6004 stats uri /admin?stats
6005 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6006 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6007 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006008
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006009 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6010 backend private_monitoring
6011 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006012 stats uri /admin?stats
6013 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006014
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006015 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006016
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006017
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006018stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6019 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020 Access control for statistics
6021
6022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 no | no | yes | yes
6024
6025 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6026 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6027 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6028 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6029 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6030 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6031
6032 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6033 instance.
6034
6035 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6036 about ACL usage.
6037
6038
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006039stats realm <realm>
6040 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | no | yes | yes
6043 Arguments :
6044 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6045 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6046 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6047
6048 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6049 using a backslash ('\').
6050
6051 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6052 only related to authentication.
6053
6054 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6055 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6056 unobvious parameters.
6057
6058 Example :
6059 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6060 backend public_www
6061 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6062 stats enable
6063 stats hide-version
6064 stats scope .
6065 stats uri /admin?stats
6066 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6067 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6068 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6069
6070 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6071 backend private_monitoring
6072 stats enable
6073 stats uri /admin?stats
6074 stats refresh 5s
6075
6076 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6077
6078
6079stats refresh <delay>
6080 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments :
6084 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6085 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6086 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6087 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6088 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6089 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6090
6091 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6092 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6093 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6094 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6095
6096 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6097 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6098 unobvious parameters.
6099
6100 Example :
6101 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6102 backend public_www
6103 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6104 stats enable
6105 stats hide-version
6106 stats scope .
6107 stats uri /admin?stats
6108 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6109 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6110 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6111
6112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6113 backend private_monitoring
6114 stats enable
6115 stats uri /admin?stats
6116 stats refresh 5s
6117
6118 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6119
6120
6121stats scope { <name> | "." }
6122 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6124 yes | no | yes | yes
6125 Arguments :
6126 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6127 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6128 section in which the statement appears.
6129
6130 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6131 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6132 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6133 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6134 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6135 exists.
6136
6137 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6138 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6139 unobvious parameters.
6140
6141 Example :
6142 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6143 backend public_www
6144 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6145 stats enable
6146 stats hide-version
6147 stats scope .
6148 stats uri /admin?stats
6149 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6150 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6151 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6152
6153 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6154 backend private_monitoring
6155 stats enable
6156 stats uri /admin?stats
6157 stats refresh 5s
6158
6159 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6160
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006161
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006162stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006163 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 yes | no | yes | yes
6166
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006167 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006168 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6169
6170 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6171 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6172
6173 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6174 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006175 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006176
6177 Example :
6178 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6179 backend private_monitoring
6180 stats enable
6181 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6182 stats uri /admin?stats
6183 stats refresh 5s
6184
6185 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6186 global section.
6187
6188
6189stats show-legends
6190 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6191 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6192 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6193 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6194 - IP (socket, server)
6195 - cookie (backend, server)
6196
6197 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6198 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006199 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006200
6201 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6202
6203
6204stats show-node [ <name> ]
6205 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 yes | no | yes | yes
6208 Arguments:
6209 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6210 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6211
6212 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6213 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006214 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006215
6216 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6217 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6218 unobvious parameters.
6219
6220 Example:
6221 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6222 backend private_monitoring
6223 stats enable
6224 stats show-node Europe-1
6225 stats uri /admin?stats
6226 stats refresh 5s
6227
6228 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6229 section.
6230
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006231
6232stats uri <prefix>
6233 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | no | yes | yes
6236 Arguments :
6237 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6238 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6239 query string.
6240
6241 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6242 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6243 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6244 possible to reach it in the application.
6245
6246 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006247 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006248 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6249 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6250 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6251 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6252
6253 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6254 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6255 an address or a port to statistics only.
6256
6257 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6258 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6259 unobvious parameters.
6260
6261 Example :
6262 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6263 backend public_www
6264 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6265 stats enable
6266 stats hide-version
6267 stats scope .
6268 stats uri /admin?stats
6269 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6270 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6271 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6272
6273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6274 backend private_monitoring
6275 stats enable
6276 stats uri /admin?stats
6277 stats refresh 5s
6278
6279 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6280
6281
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006282stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6283 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006285 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006286
6287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006288 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006289 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6290 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6291 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6292
6293 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6294 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6295 the "stick-table" statement.
6296
6297 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6298 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6299 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6300 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6301 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6302
6303 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6304 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6305 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6306 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6307 transformation rules.
6308
6309 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6310 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6311 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6312 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6313 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6314 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6315 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6316
6317 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6318 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6319 ACL based conditions.
6320
6321 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6322 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6323 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6324 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6325
6326 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6327 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6328 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6329 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6330
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006331 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6332 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6333 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6334
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006335 Example :
6336 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6337 # last 30 minutes
6338 backend pop
6339 mode tcp
6340 balance roundrobin
6341 stick store-request src
6342 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6343 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6344 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6345
6346 backend smtp
6347 mode tcp
6348 balance roundrobin
6349 stick match src table pop
6350 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6351 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6352
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006353 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6354 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006355
6356
6357stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6358 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 no | no | yes | yes
6361
6362 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6363 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6364 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6365 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6366
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006367 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6368 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6369 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6370
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006371 Examples :
6372 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006373 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006374
6375 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6376 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6377 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6378
6379
6380 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6381 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6382 backend http
6383 mode http
6384 balance roundrobin
6385 stick on src table https
6386 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6387 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6388 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6389
6390 backend https
6391 mode tcp
6392 balance roundrobin
6393 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6394 stick on src
6395 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6396 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6397
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006398 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006399
6400
6401stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6402 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 no | no | yes | yes
6405
6406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006407 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006408 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6409 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6410 server is selected.
6411
6412 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6413 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6414 the "stick-table" statement.
6415
6416 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6417 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6418 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6419 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6420 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6421 address.
6422
6423 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6424 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6425 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6426 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6427 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6428 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6429 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6430 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6431 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6432 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6433
6434 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6435 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6436 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6437 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6438 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6439 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6440 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6441
6442 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6443 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6444 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6445 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6446
6447 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6448 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6449 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6450 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6451 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6452 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006453 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6454 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6455 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6456 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6457 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6458 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006459
6460 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6461 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6462 the request.
6463
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006464 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6465 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6466 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6467
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006468 Example :
6469 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6470 # last 30 minutes
6471 backend pop
6472 mode tcp
6473 balance roundrobin
6474 stick store-request src
6475 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6476 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6477 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6478
6479 backend smtp
6480 mode tcp
6481 balance roundrobin
6482 stick match src table pop
6483 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6484 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006486 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6487 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006488
6489
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006490stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006491 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6492 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006493 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006495 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006496
6497 Arguments :
6498 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6499 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6500 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6501 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6502
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006503 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6504 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6505 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6506 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6507
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006508 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6509 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6510 instance.
6511
6512 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6513 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6514 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6515 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6516 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6517 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006518 to 32 characters.
6519
6520 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6521 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6522 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6523 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6524 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6525 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006526
6527 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006528 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6529 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006530 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6531 increase.
6532
6533 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006534 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6535 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6536 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006537
6538 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6539 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6540 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6541 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6542 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6543 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6544 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6545 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6546 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6547 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6548 parameter (see below).
6549
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006550 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6551 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6552 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6553 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6554 soft restart.
6555
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006556 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6557
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006558 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6559 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6560 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6561 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6562 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006563 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006564 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6565 if not expiration delay is specified.
6566
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006567 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6568 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6569 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6570 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006571 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6572 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6573 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6574 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6575 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6576 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6577 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6578 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6579 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6580 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6581 types and their arguments.
6582
6583 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6584 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6585 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6586 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6587
6588 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6589 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6590 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6591 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6592
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006593 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6594 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6595 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6596 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6597 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6598 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6599
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006600 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6601 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6602 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6603 they were received.
6604
6605 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6606 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6607 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6608 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6609 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6610
6611 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6612 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6613 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6614 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6615 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6616
6617 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6618 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6619 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6620
6621 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6622 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6623 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6624 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6625 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6626
6627 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6628 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6629 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6630 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6631 the client side.
6632
6633 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6634 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6636 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6637 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6638 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6639 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6640
6641 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6642 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6643 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6644 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6645 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6646 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6647 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6648
6649 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6652 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6653 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6654 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6655
6656 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6657 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6658 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6659 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6660
6661 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6662 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6663 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6664 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6665 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6666 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6667 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6668 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6669 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6670 recommended for better fairness.
6671
6672 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6673 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6674 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6675 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6676
6677 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6678 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6679 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6680 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6681 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6682 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6683 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6684 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6685 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6686 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006687
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006688 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6689 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006690 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6691 reference it.
6692
6693 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6694 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6695 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6696 as an exclusive stickiness.
6697
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006698 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6699 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6700 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6701 something that can be ignored.
6702
6703 Example:
6704 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6705 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6706 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6707 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6708
6709 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006710 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006711
6712
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006713stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6714 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 no | no | yes | yes
6717
6718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006719 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006720 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6721 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6722 server is selected.
6723
6724 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6725 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6726 the "stick-table" statement.
6727
6728 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6729 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6730 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6731 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6732
6733 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6734 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6735 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6736 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6737 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6738 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006739 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006740 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6741 rules.
6742
6743 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6744 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6745 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6746 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6747 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6748 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6749 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6750
6751 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6752 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6753 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6754 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6755
6756 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6757 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6758 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6759 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6760 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6761 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006762 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6763 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6764 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6765 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6766 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6767 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6768 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6769 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6770 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006771
6772 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6773
6774 Example :
6775 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6776 backend https
6777 mode tcp
6778 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006779 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006780 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006781
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006782 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6783 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6784
6785 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6786 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6787 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6788
6789 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6790 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006791
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006792 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6793 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6794 # at offset 44.
6795
6796 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6797 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6798
6799 # Learn on response if server hello.
6800 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006801
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006802 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6803 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6804
6805 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6806 extraction.
6807
6808
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006809tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6810 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6812 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006813 Arguments :
6814 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006815 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6816 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006818 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006819
6820 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6821 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006822 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6823 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6824 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6825 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6826 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6827 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006829 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6830 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6831 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6832 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006834 Three types of actions are supported :
6835 - accept :
6836 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6838 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006840 - reject :
6841 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6842 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6843 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6844 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6845 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6846 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6847 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6848 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6849 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6850 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6851 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6852 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006853
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006854 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6855 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6856 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6857 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6858 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6859 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6860 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6861 hosts.
6862
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006863 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006864 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6865 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6866 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006867 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6868 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006869 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006870 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6871 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6872 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6873 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6874 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006876 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006877 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006878 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006879 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6880 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6881 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6882 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006884 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6885 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6886 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6887 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006889 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6890 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6891 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6892 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6893 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006894 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6895 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6896 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6897 layer7 information is extracted.
6898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006899 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6900 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6901 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6902 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6903 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006905 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6906 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6907 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006909 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6910 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6911 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006913 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006914 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006915 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006917 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6918 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6919 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006921 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006922 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6923 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006924
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006925 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6926
6927 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6928
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006929 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006931 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006932
6933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006934tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6935 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006937 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006938 Arguments :
6939 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006940 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6941 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006942 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006944 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006946 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6947 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6948 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6949 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6950 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006952 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6953 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6954 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6955 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006956 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
6957 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
6958 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
6959 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
6960 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
6961 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
6962 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditionned by an
6963 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006965 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6966 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6967 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6968 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006970 Three types of actions are supported :
6971 - accept :
6972 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006973 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006975 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6976 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006977
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006978 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
6979 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
6980 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
6981 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
6982 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
6983 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006985 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006986 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6987 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006989 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006990 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6991 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6992 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6993 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006994 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
6995 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
6996 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006997
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006998 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6999 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7000 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7001 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7002
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007003 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007004 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7005 # and reject everything else.
7006 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7007 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007008 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007009 tcp-request content reject
7010
7011 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007012 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7013 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7014 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007015 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007016
7017 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7018 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7019 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007020 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007021 tcp-request content reject
7022
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007023 Example:
7024 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7025 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007026 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007027
7028 Example:
7029 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7030 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007031 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007033 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7034 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7035
7036 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007037 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007038 # protecting all our sites
7039 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007040 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7041 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007042 ...
7043 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7044
7045 backend http_dynamic
7046 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007047 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007048 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007049 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7050 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7051 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007052 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007054 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007056 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007057
7058
7059tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7060 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007062 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007063 Arguments :
7064 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7065 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7066 as explained at the top of this document.
7067
7068 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7069 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7070 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7071 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7072 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7073
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007074 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7075 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7076 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7077 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7078
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007079 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7080 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007081 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007082 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007083 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7084 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7085 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7086 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007087
7088 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7089 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7090 it pass through unaffected.
7091
7092 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7093 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7094 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007095 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007096 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7097 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007098 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7099 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7100 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007101
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007102 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007103 "timeout client".
7104
7105
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007106tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7107 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | no | yes | yes
7110 Arguments :
7111 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007112 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007113
7114 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7115
7116 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7117 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7118 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007119 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7120 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007121
7122 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7123
7124 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7125 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7126 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7127 inserted.
7128
7129 Two types of actions are supported :
7130 - accept :
7131 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7132 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7133 the rules evaluation.
7134
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007135 - close :
7136 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7137 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7138 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7139 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7140 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7141 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7142 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7143 protocols.
7144
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007145 - reject :
7146 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7147 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007148 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007149
7150 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7151 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7152 for changing the default action to a reject.
7153
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007154 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7155 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7156 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7157 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007158 period.
7159
7160 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7161
7162 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7163
7164
7165tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7166 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7168 no | no | yes | yes
7169 Arguments :
7170 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7172 as explained at the top of this document.
7173
7174 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7175
7176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007177timeout check <timeout>
7178 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7179 established.
7180
7181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7182 yes | no | yes | yes
7183 Arguments:
7184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7186 as explained at the top of this document.
7187
7188 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7189 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7190 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7191 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007192 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7193 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7194 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007195
7196 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7197 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7198
7199 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7200 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007201 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007202
7203 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7204 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7205 forget about it.
7206
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007207 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7208 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007209
7210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007211timeout client <timeout>
7212timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7213 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7215 yes | yes | yes | no
7216 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007217 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007218 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7219 as explained at the top of this document.
7220
7221 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7222 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7223 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7224 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7225 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7226 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7227 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7228 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007229 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007230 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007231 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7232 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7233 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007234
7235 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7236 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7237 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7238 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7239 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7240 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7241
7242 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7243 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7244 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7245
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007246 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007247
7248
7249timeout connect <timeout>
7250timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7251 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 yes | no | yes | yes
7254 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007255 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7257 as explained at the top of this document.
7258
7259 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007260 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007261 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007262 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007263 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7264 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007265
7266 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7267 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7268 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7269 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7270 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7271 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7272
7273 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7274 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7275 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7276
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007277 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7278 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007279
7280
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007281timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7282 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7284 yes | yes | yes | yes
7285 Arguments :
7286 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7287 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7288 as explained at the top of this document.
7289
7290 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7291 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7292 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7293 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7294 once the request has started to present itself.
7295
7296 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7297 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7298 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7299 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7300 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7301
7302 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7303 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7304 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7305 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7306
7307 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7308 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7309 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7310 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7311 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007312 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007313
7314 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7315 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7316 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7317 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7318
7319 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7320
7321
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007322timeout http-request <timeout>
7323 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007325 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7329 as explained at the top of this document.
7330
7331 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7332 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7333 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7334 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7335 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7336 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7337 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7338 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7339
7340 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7341 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007342 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7343 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007344
7345 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7346 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7347 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7348 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7349 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7350
7351 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007352 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7353 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7354 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007355
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007356 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007357
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007358
7359timeout queue <timeout>
7360 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7362 yes | no | yes | yes
7363 Arguments :
7364 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7365 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7366 as explained at the top of this document.
7367
7368 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7369 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7370 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7371 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7372 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7373
7374 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7375 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7376 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7377 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7378
7379 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7380
7381
7382timeout server <timeout>
7383timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7384 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7386 yes | no | yes | yes
7387 Arguments :
7388 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7389 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7390 as explained at the top of this document.
7391
7392 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7393 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7394 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7395 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7396 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7397 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7398 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7399
7400 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7401 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7402 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7403 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7404 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007405 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007406 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007407 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7408 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7409 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7410 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007411
7412 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7413 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7414 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7415 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7416 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7417 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7418
7419 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7420 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7421 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7422
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007423 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007424
7425
7426timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007427 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | yes | yes | yes
7430 Arguments :
7431 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7432 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7433 as explained at the top of this document.
7434
7435 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7436 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7437 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7438
7439 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7440 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7441 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7442 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007443 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007444
7445 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7446
7447
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007448timeout tunnel <timeout>
7449 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7451 yes | no | yes | yes
7452 Arguments :
7453 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7454 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7455 as explained at the top of this document.
7456
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007457 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007458 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7459 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7460 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7461 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7462 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7463 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7464 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7465 specified.
7466
7467 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7468 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7469 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7470 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7471 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7472
7473 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7474 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7475 forget about it.
7476
7477 Example :
7478 defaults http
7479 option http-server-close
7480 timeout connect 5s
7481 timeout client 30s
7482 timeout client 30s
7483 timeout server 30s
7484 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7485
7486 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7487
7488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007489transparent (deprecated)
7490 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007492 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007493 Arguments : none
7494
7495 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7496 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7497 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7498 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7499 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7500 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7501 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7502 appropriate server.
7503
7504 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7505
7506 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7507 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7508
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007509 See also: "option transparent"
7510
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007511unique-id-format <string>
7512 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | yes | yes | no
7515 Arguments :
7516 <string> is a log-format string.
7517
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007518 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7519 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7520 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7521 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007523 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7524 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7525 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7526 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7527 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7528 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7529 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7530 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007532 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7533 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007535 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007536
7537 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7538
7539 will generate:
7540
7541 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7542
7543 See also: "unique-id-header"
7544
7545unique-id-header <name>
7546 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7548 yes | yes | yes | no
7549 Arguments :
7550 <name> is the name of the header.
7551
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007552 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7553 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007555 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007556
7557 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7558 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7559
7560 will generate:
7561
7562 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7563
7564 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007565
7566use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7567use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007568 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 no | yes | yes | no
7571 Arguments :
7572 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007574 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007575
7576 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7577 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7578 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007579 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7580 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7581 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7582 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007583
7584 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7585 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7586 assign the backend.
7587
7588 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7589 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7590 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7591 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7592 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7593 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7594
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007595 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007596 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007597 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7598 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7599 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7600
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007601 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007602
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007603
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007604use-server <server> if <condition>
7605use-server <server> unless <condition>
7606 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7608 no | no | yes | yes
7609 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007610 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007611
7612 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7613
7614 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7615 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7616 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7617
7618 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7619 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7620 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7621 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7622 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7623 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7624 matches will assign the server.
7625
7626 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7627 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7628 with the next rules until one matches.
7629
7630 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7631 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7632 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7633 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7634
7635 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7636 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7637 stripped.
7638
7639 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7640 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7641 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7642 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7643
7644 Example :
7645 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7646 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7647 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7648 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7649 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7650 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7651 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7652 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7653 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7654
7655 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7656
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007657
76585. Bind and Server options
7659--------------------------
7660
7661The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7662depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7663settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7664written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7665described in this section.
7666
7667
76685.1. Bind options
7669-----------------
7670
7671The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7672as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7673no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7674parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7675while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7676provided immediately after the setting name.
7677
7678The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7679
7680accept-proxy
7681 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7682 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7683 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7684 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7685 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7686 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7687 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7688 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7689 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007690 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7691 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007692
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007693alpn <protocols>
7694 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7695 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7696 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7697 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7698 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7699 initial NPN extension.
7700
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007701backlog <backlog>
7702 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7703 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7704
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007705ecdhe <named curve>
7706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007707 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7708 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007709
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007710ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7712 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7713 client's certificate.
7714
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007715ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7717 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7718 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7719 error is ignored.
7720
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007721ciphers <ciphers>
7722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7723 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7724 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7725 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7726 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7727
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007728crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7730 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7731 to verify client's certificate.
7732
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007733crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7735 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7736 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7737 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7738 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7739 file.
7740
7741 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7742 are loaded.
7743
7744 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7745 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7746 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7747 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7748 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7749 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7750 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7751 www.sub.example.org).
7752
7753 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7754 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7755 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7756 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7757 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7758
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007759 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007760
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007761 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7762 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7763 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7764 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7765 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7766 clients).
7767
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007768crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7770 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7771 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7772 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007773
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007774crt-list <file>
7775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007776 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7777 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007778
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007779 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007780
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007781 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7782 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7783 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7784 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7785 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7786 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7787 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7788 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007790defer-accept
7791 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7792 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7793 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7794 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7795 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7796 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7797 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7798 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7799 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7800 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7801 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7802
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007803force-sslv3
7804 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7805 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7806 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7807
7808force-tlsv10
7809 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7810 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7811
7812force-tlsv11
7813 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7814 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7815
7816force-tlsv12
7817 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7818 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007820gid <gid>
7821 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7822 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7823 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7824 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7825 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7826
7827group <group>
7828 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7829 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7830 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7831 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7832 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7833
7834id <id>
7835 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7836 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7837 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7838 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7839
7840interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007841 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7842 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7843 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7844 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7845 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7846 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7847 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007848
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007849level <level>
7850 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7851 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7852 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7853 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7854 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7855 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7856 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7857 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7858 counters).
7859 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7860 all counters).
7861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007862maxconn <maxconn>
7863 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7864 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7865 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7866 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7867 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7868 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7869 eat all memory.
7870
7871mode <mode>
7872 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7873 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7874 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7875 UNIX sockets.
7876
7877mss <maxseg>
7878 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7879 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7880 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7881 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7882 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7883 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7884 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7885 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7886 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7887 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7888 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7889
7890name <name>
7891 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7892 page.
7893
7894nice <nice>
7895 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7896 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7897 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7898 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7899 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7900 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7901 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7902 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7903 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7904 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7905 one for an RDP socket.
7906
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007907no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7909 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7910 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007911 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7912 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007913
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007914no-tls-tickets
7915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7916 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7917 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7918 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7919
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007920no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007922 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7923 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7924 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7925 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007926
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007927no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007929 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7930 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7931 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7932 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007933
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007934no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007936 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7937 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7938 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7939 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007940
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007941npn <protocols>
7942 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7943 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7944 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7945 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007946 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7947 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007949ssl
7950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7951 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7952 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7953 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7954 to deciphered contents.
7955
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007956strict-sni
7957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7958 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7959 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7960 See the "crt" option for more information.
7961
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007962tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007963 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007964 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7965 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7966 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7967 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7968 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7969 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7970 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007971 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7972 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7973 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007974
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007975transparent
7976 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7977 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7978 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7979 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7980 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7981 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7982 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7983 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7984 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7985 so check for support with your vendor.
7986
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007987v4v6
7988 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7989 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7990 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7991 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7992 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7993
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007994v6only
7995 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7996 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7997 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007998 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7999 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008001uid <uid>
8002 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8003 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8004 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8005 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8006 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8007
8008user <user>
8009 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8010 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8011 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8012 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8013 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8014
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008015verify [none|optional|required]
8016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8017 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8018 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8019 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8020 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008021 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8022 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8023 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8024 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020080265.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008027------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008029The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8030which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8031arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8032settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8033after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8034Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8035address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008037 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008038 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008040The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008041
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008042addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008043 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8044 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8045 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8046 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8047 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008049 Supported in default-server: No
8050
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008051agent-check
8052 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8053 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8054 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8055 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8056
8057 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8058 e.g. "75%"
8059
8060 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8061 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8062
8063 * The string "drain".
8064
8065 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8066 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8067 persistence.
8068
8069 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8070
8071 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8072
8073 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8074
8075 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8076
8077 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8078
8079 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8080
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008081 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8082 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8083 parameter.
8084
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008085 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8086 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8087
8088 Supported in default-server: No
8089
8090agent-inter <delay>
8091 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8092 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8093
8094 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8095 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8096 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8097 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8098 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8099 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8100 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8101 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8102 of backends use the same servers.
8103
8104 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8105
8106 Supported in default-server: Yes
8107
8108agent-port <port>
8109 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8110
8111 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8112
8113 Supported in default-server: Yes
8114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008115backup
8116 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8117 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8118 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8119 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8120 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8121 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008123 Supported in default-server: No
8124
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008125ca-file <cafile>
8126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8127 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8128 server's certificate.
8129
8130 Supported in default-server: No
8131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008132check
8133 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008134 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8135 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8136 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8137 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8138 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8139 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8140 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008141 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8142 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8143 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008145 Supported in default-server: No
8146
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008147check-send-proxy
8148 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8149 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8150 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8151 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8152 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8153 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8154 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8155
8156 Supported in default-server: No
8157
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008158check-ssl
8159 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8160 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8161 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8162 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8163 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8164 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8165 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8166 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8167 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8168
8169 Supported in default-server: No
8170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008171ciphers <ciphers>
8172 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8173 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8174 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8175 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8176 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8177 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8178 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8179 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8180
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008181 Supported in default-server: No
8182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008183cookie <value>
8184 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8185 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8186 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8187 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8188 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8189 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8190 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008192 Supported in default-server: No
8193
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008194crl-file <crlfile>
8195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8196 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8197 to verify server's certificate.
8198
8199 Supported in default-server: No
8200
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008201crt <cert>
8202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8203 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8204 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8205 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8206 certificate request.
8207
8208 Supported in default-server: No
8209
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008210disabled
8211 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8212 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8213 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8214 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8215 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8216
8217 Supported in default-server: No
8218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008219error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008220 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8221 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8222 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008224 Supported in default-server: Yes
8225
8226 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008228fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008229 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8230 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8231 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008233 Supported in default-server: Yes
8234
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008235force-sslv3
8236 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8237 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8238 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8239
8240 Supported in default-server: No
8241
8242force-tlsv10
8243 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8244 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8245
8246 Supported in default-server: No
8247
8248force-tlsv11
8249 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8250 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8251
8252 Supported in default-server: No
8253
8254force-tlsv12
8255 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8256 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8257
8258 Supported in default-server: No
8259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008260id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008261 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8262 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8263 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008265 Supported in default-server: No
8266
8267inter <delay>
8268fastinter <delay>
8269downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008270 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8271 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8272 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8273 between checks depending on the server state :
8274
8275 Server state | Interval used
8276 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8277 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8278 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8279 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8280 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8281 or yet unchecked. |
8282 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8283 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8284 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008286 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8287 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8288 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8289 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008290 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8291 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8292 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8293 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8294 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008296 Supported in default-server: Yes
8297
8298maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008299 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8300 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8301 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8302 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8303 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8304 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8305 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8306 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008308 Supported in default-server: Yes
8309
8310maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008311 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8312 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8313 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8314 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8315 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8316 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8317 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008319 Supported in default-server: Yes
8320
8321minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008322 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8323 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8324 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8325 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8326 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8327 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008328 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008329 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008331 Supported in default-server: Yes
8332
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008333no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008334 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8335 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008336 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008337
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008338 Supported in default-server: No
8339
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008340no-tls-tickets
8341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8342 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8343 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8344 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8345
8346 Supported in default-server: No
8347
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008348no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008349 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008350 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8351 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008352 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8353 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008354
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008355 Supported in default-server: No
8356
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008357no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008358 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008359 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8360 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008361 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8362 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008363
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008364 Supported in default-server: No
8365
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008366no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008367 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008368 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8369 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008370 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8371 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008372
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008373 Supported in default-server: No
8374
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008375non-stick
8376 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8377 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8378 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8379
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008380 Supported in default-server: No
8381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008382observe <mode>
8383 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8384 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8385 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8386 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8387 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8388 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008389 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008391 Supported in default-server: No
8392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008393 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008395on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008396 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8397 Currently, four modes are available:
8398 - fastinter: force fastinter
8399 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8400 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8401 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8402 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008404 Supported in default-server: Yes
8405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008406 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8407
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008408on-marked-down <action>
8409 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8410 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008411 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8412 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8413 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8414 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8415 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8416 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8417 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8418 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008419
8420 Actions are disabled by default
8421
8422 Supported in default-server: Yes
8423
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008424on-marked-up <action>
8425 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8426 Currently one action is available:
8427 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8428 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8429 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8430 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8431 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8432 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8433 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8434 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8435
8436 Actions are disabled by default
8437
8438 Supported in default-server: Yes
8439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008440port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008441 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8442 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8443 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8444 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8445 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8446 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008448 Supported in default-server: Yes
8449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008450redir <prefix>
8451 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8452 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8453 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8454 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8455 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8456 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8457 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8458 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008459 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8461 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8462 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8463 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8464 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8465
8466 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008468 Supported in default-server: No
8469
8470rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008471 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8472 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8473 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008475 Supported in default-server: Yes
8476
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008477send-proxy
8478 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8479 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8480 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8481 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8482 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8483 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8484 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8485 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8486 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008487 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8488 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8489 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8490 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8491 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008492
8493 Supported in default-server: No
8494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008495slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008496 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8497 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8498 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8499 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8500 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8501 parameters :
8502
8503 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8504 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8505
8506 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8507 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8508 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8509 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8510
8511 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8512 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8513 seen as failed.
8514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008515 Supported in default-server: Yes
8516
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008517source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008518source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008519source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008520 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8521 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8522 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8523 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8524
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008525 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8526 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8527 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8528 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8529 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8530 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8531 server.
8532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008533 Supported in default-server: No
8534
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008535ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008536 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8537 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8538 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8539 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8540 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8541 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8542 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008543
8544 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008546track [<proxy>/]<server>
8547 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8548 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8549 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8550 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8551 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008553 Supported in default-server: No
8554
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008555verify [none|required]
8556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008557 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8558 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8559 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8560 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008561 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8562 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8563 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008564
8565 Supported in default-server: No
8566
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008567verifyhost <hostname>
8568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8569 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8570 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8571 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8572 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8573 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8574
8575 Supported in default-server: No
8576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008577weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008578 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8579 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8580 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008581 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8582 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8583 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8584 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8585 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8586 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008588 Supported in default-server: Yes
8589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008590
85916. HTTP header manipulation
8592---------------------------
8593
8594In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8595response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8596request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8597which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8598against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8599to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8600passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8601headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8602never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8603
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008604There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8605(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8606rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8607messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8608in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008609happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008610add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8611normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008613This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8614in section 4.2 :
8615
8616 - reqadd <string>
8617 - reqallow <search>
8618 - reqiallow <search>
8619 - reqdel <search>
8620 - reqidel <search>
8621 - reqdeny <search>
8622 - reqideny <search>
8623 - reqpass <search>
8624 - reqipass <search>
8625 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8626 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8627 - reqtarpit <search>
8628 - reqitarpit <search>
8629 - rspadd <string>
8630 - rspdel <search>
8631 - rspidel <search>
8632 - rspdeny <search>
8633 - rspideny <search>
8634 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8635 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8636
8637With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8638is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8639parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8640prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8641Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8642
8643 \t for a tab
8644 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8645 \n for a new line (LF)
8646 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8647 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8648 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8649 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8650 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8651
8652The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8653portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8654above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8655regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
86569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8657is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8658
8659The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8660after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8661
8662Notes related to these keywords :
8663---------------------------------
8664 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8665 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8666 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8667
8668 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8669 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8670 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8671
8672 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8673 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8674 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8675 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8676 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8677
8678 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8679 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8680 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8681 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8682 useless headers before adding new ones.
8683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008684 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008685 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8686
8687 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8688 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8689 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8690
8691 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8692 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008693 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008694
8695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8697----------------------------------
8698
8699Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8700client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8701The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8702these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8703but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8704data called patterns.
8705
8706
87077.1. ACL basics
8708---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008709
8710The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8711content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8712from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8713simple :
8714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008715 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008716 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008717 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8718 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008720The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8721adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008722
8723In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008725 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008726
8727This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8728Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8729and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008730an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8731conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8732as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8733are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008734
8735ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8736'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8737which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8738
8739There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8740performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008742The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8743specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8744this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008745methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8746ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008747
8748Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8749 - boolean
8750 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8751 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8752 - string
8753 - data block
8754
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008755Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8756converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8757would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8758The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8759which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008761The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8762 - boolean
8763 - integer or integer range
8764 - IP address / network
8765 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8766 - regular expression
8767 - hex block
8768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008769The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8770
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008771 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8772 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008773 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008774 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8777read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8778if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8779lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8780will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8781beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8782a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8783lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8784exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8785
8786Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8787loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8788
8789 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8790
8791In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8792the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8793case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8794as well.
8795
8796The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8797sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8798do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8799methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8800is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8801obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8802followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8803default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8804that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8805string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8806
8807There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8808sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8809be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008810
8811 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8812 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008813 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8814 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8815 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8816 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008817
8818 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8819 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008820 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008821
8822 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008823 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008824
8825 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008826 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008827
8828 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8829 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8830
8831 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8832 binary or string samples.
8833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008834 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8835 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008837 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8838 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8839 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008841 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8842 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008844 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8845 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008847 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8848 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008850 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8851 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008852 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008854 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8855 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8856 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008857
8858For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8859request, it is possible to do :
8860
8861 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8862
8863In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8864buffer, one would use the following acl :
8865
8866 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8867
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008868On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8869possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8870
8871 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008873All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8874criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8875method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8876to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8877criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8878the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008880If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8881the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8882example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008884 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8885 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8886 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8887 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008888
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008889
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008890The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008891and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8892combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8893the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008895 +-------------------------------------------------+
8896 | Input sample type |
8897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8898 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8900 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008902 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008904 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008905 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008906 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008907 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008908 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008909 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008910 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008911 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008912 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008913 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008914 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008915 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008916 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008917 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008918 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008919 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008920 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008921 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008922 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008923 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8924 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8925 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008926
8927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089287.1.1. Matching booleans
8929------------------------
8930
8931In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8932Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8933When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8934that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8935
8936Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8937return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8938"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089417.1.2. Matching integers
8942------------------------
8943
8944Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8945enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8946to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8947
8948Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8949matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8950lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008951
8952For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8953unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8954representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8955
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008956As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8957two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8958instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8959ranges and operators.
8960
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008961For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008962operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8963Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8964of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008966Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008967
8968 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8969 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8970 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8971 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8972 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008974For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008975
8976 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8977
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008978This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8979
8980 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8981
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089837.1.3. Matching strings
8984-----------------------
8985
8986String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8987different forms :
8988
8989 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8990 patterns ;
8991
8992 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8993 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8994
8995 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8996 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8997
8998 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8999 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9000
9001 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9002 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9003 matches.
9004
9005 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9006 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9007 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009008
9009String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9010exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9011characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9012string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9013to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009014before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009015
9016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090177.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9018---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009019
9020Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9021they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9022possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9023passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9024the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009025the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9026match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009027
9028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090297.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9030-------------------------------------
9031
9032It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9033not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9034a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9035to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9036digits may be used upper or lower case.
9037
9038Example :
9039 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9040 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9041
9042
90437.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9044---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009045
9046IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9047netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9048within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009049host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009050difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9051at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9052does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9053parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009054
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009055IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9056Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9057trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9058IPv6 patterns.
9059
9060HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9061following situations :
9062 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9063 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9064 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9065 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9066 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9067 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9068 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9069 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9070 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9071 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009073
90747.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9075----------------------------------
9076
9077Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9078combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9079
9080 - AND (implicit)
9081 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9082 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009084A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009086 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009088Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9089indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009091For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9092"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9093requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9094is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9095
9096 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9097 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9098 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9099 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9100
9101To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9102and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9103
9104 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9105 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9106 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9107 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9108
9109 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9110 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9111 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9112 use_backend www if host_www
9113
9114It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9115expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9116be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9117the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9118
9119 The following rule :
9120
9121 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9122 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9123
9124 Can also be written that way :
9125
9126 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9127
9128It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9129to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9130simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9131sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9132good use is the following :
9133
9134 With named ACLs :
9135
9136 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9137 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9138 monitor fail if site_dead
9139
9140 With anonymous ACLs :
9141
9142 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9143
9144See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9145
9146
91477.3. Fetching samples
9148---------------------
9149
9150Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9151against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9152sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9153ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9154of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9155available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9156
9157This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9158Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9159compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9160deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9161
9162The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9163matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9164method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9165indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9166
9167As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9168when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9169mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9170the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9171ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9172
9173Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9174multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9175when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9176incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9177are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9178is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9179all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9180
9181Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9182 - name
9183 - name(arg1)
9184 - name(arg1,arg2)
9185
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009186Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9187of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9188is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9189was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9190has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9191unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9192
9193These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9194sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9195the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9196support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009198The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009200 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9201 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9202 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009204 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9205 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9206 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009208 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9209 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9210 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9211 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9212 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9213
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009214 http_date([<offset>])
9215 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9216 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9217 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9218 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9219 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9220 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9221 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9222 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009223
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009224 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9225 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9226 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9227 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9228 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9229 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9230 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9231 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9232 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9233 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9234 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9235 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9236 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9237 the map* converters.
9238
9239 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9240 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9241 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9242 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9243
9244 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9245 | `-_ out | | | |
9246 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9247 | / match `-_ | | | |
9248 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9249 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9250 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9251 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9252 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9253 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9254 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9255 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9256 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9257 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9258
9259 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9260 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9261 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9262 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9263 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9264 trailing spaces/tabs.
9265
9266 Example :
9267
9268 # this is a comment and is ignored
9269 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9270 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9271 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9272 | | | `----------- value
9273 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9274 | `---------------------------- key
9275 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092777.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9278--------------------------------------------
9279
9280A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9281not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9282"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9283The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9284
9285always_false : boolean
9286 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9287 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9288
9289always_true : boolean
9290 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9291 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9292
9293avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009294 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009295 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9296 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9297 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9298 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9299 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9300 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9301 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9302 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9303 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9304 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9305 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9306 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9307 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009309be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009310 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9311 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9312 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9313 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9314 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9317 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9318 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9319 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9320 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9321 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9322 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009323
9324 Example :
9325 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9326 backend dynamic
9327 mode http
9328 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9329 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009331connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9333 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9334 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9335 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009336
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009337 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009338 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009339 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009341 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9342 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009343
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009344 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009345 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009347 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9348 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009349 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009350 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009352 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9353 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009354 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009355 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009356
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009357date([<offset>]) : integer
9358 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9359 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9360 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9361 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009362 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9363
9364 Example :
9365
9366 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9367 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009368
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009369env(<name>) : string
9370 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9371 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9372 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9373 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9374 certain way.
9375
9376 Examples :
9377 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9378 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9379
9380 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9381 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009383fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9384 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009385 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9386 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009387 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9388 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9389 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9390 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9391 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009393fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9394 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9395 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9396 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9397 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9398 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9399 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9400 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9401 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009402
9403 Example :
9404 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9405 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9406 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9407 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9408 frontend mail
9409 bind :25
9410 mode tcp
9411 maxconn 100
9412 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9413 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9414 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9415 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009417nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9418 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9419 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9420 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009421 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9422 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9423 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009426 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9427 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9428 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009429 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9430 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9431 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9432 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9433 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9434
9435srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9436 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9437 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9438 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9439 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9440 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9441 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9442 methods.
9443
9444srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9445 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9446 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9447 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9448 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9449 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9450 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9451 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9452
9453srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9454 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9455 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9456 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9457 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9458 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9459 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9460 overloading servers).
9461
9462 Example :
9463 # Redirect to a separate back
9464 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9465 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9466 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9467
9468table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9469 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9470 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9471
9472table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9473 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9474 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9475 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9476
9477
94787.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9479----------------------------------
9480
9481The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9482closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9483methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9484sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9485TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009486the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9487counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9488"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009489argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9490the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9491this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009492
9493be_id : integer
9494 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9495 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9496
9497dst : ip
9498 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9499 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9500 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9501 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9502 RFC 4291.
9503
9504dst_conn : integer
9505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9506 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9507 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9508 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9509 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9510 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9511 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9512 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009514dst_port : integer
9515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9516 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9517 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9518 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9519 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9520 an HTTP header.
9521
9522fe_id : integer
9523 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9524 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9525 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9526
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009527sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9528sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9529sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9530sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009531 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9532 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9533 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9534
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009535sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9536sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9537sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9538sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009539 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9540 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9541 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9542
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009543sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9544sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9545sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9546sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009547 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9548 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009549 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9550 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9551 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009552
9553 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9554 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009555 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9556 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9557 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009558 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9559 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9560
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009561sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9562sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9563sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9564sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009565 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9566 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9567
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009568sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9569sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9570sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9571sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9573 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9574 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9575
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009576sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9577sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9578sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9579sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009580 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9581 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9582 See also src_conn_rate.
9583
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009584sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9585sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9586sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9587sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009588 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009589 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009590
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009591sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9592sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9593sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9594sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009595 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9596 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9597 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009598 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9599 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9600 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009601
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009602sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9603sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9604sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9605sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009606 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9607 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9608 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9609
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009610sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9611sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9612sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9613sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009614 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9615 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9616 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9617 src_http_err_rate.
9618
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009619sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9620sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9621sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9622sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009623 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9624 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9625 src_http_req_cnt.
9626
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009627sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9628sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9629sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9630sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009631 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9632 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9633 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9634 src_http_req_rate.
9635
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009636sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9637sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9638sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9639sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009640 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009641 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9642 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9643 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9644 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009645
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009646 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9647 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009648 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9649
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009650sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9651sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9652sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9653sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009654 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9655 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9656 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9657 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9658
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009659sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9660sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9661sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9662sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9664 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9665 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9666 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9667
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009668sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9669sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9670sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9671sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009672 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9673 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9674 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9675 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009676 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009677 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9678
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009679sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9680sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9681sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9682sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009683 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9684 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9685 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9686 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9687 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009688 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009689
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009690sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9691sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9692sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9693sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009694 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9695 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9696 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9697
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009698sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9699sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9700sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9701sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009702 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9703 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009704 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009705 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9706 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009707 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9708 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9709 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711so_id : integer
9712 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9713 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9714 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009716src : ip
9717 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9718 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9719 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9720 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9721 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9722 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9723 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009724
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009725 Example:
9726 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9727 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9730 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9731 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9732 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009733 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009735src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9736 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9737 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009738 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009739 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009741src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9742 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9743 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9744 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9745 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9746 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9747 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009748
9749 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9750 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9751 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9752 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009753 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009754 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9755 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009757src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009758 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009759 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009760 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009761 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009763src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009764 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009765 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9766 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009767 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009769src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9770 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9771 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9772 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009773 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009775src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009776 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009777 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009778 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009779 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009782 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009784 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9785 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009786 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9787 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9788 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009790src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9791 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9792 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009793 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009794 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009797src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9798 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9799 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9800 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9801 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009802 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009804src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9805 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9806 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9807 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009808 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009810src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9811 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9812 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9813 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009814 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009815 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009817src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9818 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9819 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9820 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009821 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9823 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009824
9825 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009826 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009827 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009829src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9830 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9831 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9832 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9833 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009834 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9835 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009837src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9838 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9839 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009840 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9841 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009842 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009844src_port : integer
9845 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9846 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9847 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9848 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009850src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9851 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009852 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9853 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9854 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009855 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009857src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9858 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9859 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9860 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9861 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009862 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009864src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9865 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9866 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9867 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9868 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9869 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9870 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9871 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9872 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009873
9874 Example :
9875 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9876 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9877 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9878 listen ssh
9879 bind :22
9880 mode tcp
9881 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009882 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009883 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009884 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009886srv_id : integer
9887 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9888 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9889 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009890
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098927.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9893----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009895The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9896closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9897when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9898usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9899future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009901ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9902 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9903 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9904 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9905 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9906 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9909 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9910 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9911 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9912 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009914ssl_c_err : integer
9915 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9916 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9917 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9918 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9919 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9922 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9923 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9924 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9925 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9926 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9927 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9928 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9929 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009931 ACL derivatives :
9932 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009934ssl_c_key_alg : string
9935 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9936 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9937 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939 ACL derivatives :
9940 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942ssl_c_notafter : string
9943 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9944 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9945 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947 ACL derivatives :
9948 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009950ssl_c_notbefore : string
9951 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9952 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9953 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955 ACL derivatives :
9956 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009958ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9959 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9960 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9961 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9962 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9963 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9964 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9965 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9966 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009968 ACL derivatives :
9969 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009971ssl_c_serial : binary
9972 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9973 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9974 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976 ACL derivatives :
9977 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9980 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9981 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9982 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9985 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9986 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9987 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009989 ACL derivatives :
9990 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9991
9992ssl_c_used : boolean
9993 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9994 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009996ssl_c_verify : integer
9997 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9998 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9999 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10000 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010002ssl_c_version : integer
10003 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10004 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10007 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10008 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10009 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10010 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010011 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010012 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10013 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10014 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 ACL derivatives :
10017 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019ssl_f_key_alg : string
10020 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10021 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10022 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 ACL derivatives :
10025 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027ssl_f_notafter : string
10028 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10029 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10030 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 ACL derivatives :
10033 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035ssl_f_notbefore : string
10036 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10037 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10038 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040 ACL derivatives :
10041 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010043ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10044 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10045 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10046 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10047 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10048 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10049 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10050 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10051 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053 ACL derivatives :
10054 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010056ssl_f_serial : binary
10057 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10058 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10059 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010061 ACL derivatives :
10062 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010064ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10065 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10066 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10067 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069 ACL derivatives :
10070 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010072ssl_f_version : integer
10073 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10074 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10075
10076ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010077 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10078 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10079 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081 Example :
10082 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10083 listen http-https
10084 bind :80
10085 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10086 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10087
10088ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10089 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10090 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10091
10092ssl_fc_alpn : string
10093 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10094 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10095 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10096 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10097 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10098 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10099 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10100 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10101 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10102
10103 ACL derivatives :
10104 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106ssl_fc_cipher : string
10107 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10108 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110 ACL derivatives :
10111 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010114 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10115 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010116 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10117 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10118 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10119 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10122 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010123 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10124 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10125 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10126 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010128ssl_fc_npn : string
10129 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10130 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10131 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10132 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10133 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10134 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10135 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10136 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138 ACL derivatives :
10139 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141ssl_fc_protocol : string
10142 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10143 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145 ACL derivatives :
10146 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10147
10148ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10149 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10150 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10151 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10152 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154ssl_fc_sni : string
10155 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10156 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10157 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10158 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10159 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10160
10161 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10162 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10163 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010164 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10165 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010167 ACL derivatives :
10168 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10169 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10170 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10173 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10174 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010175
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101777.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10178------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10181sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10182only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10183For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10184be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10185can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10186sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10187for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10188content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10191 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10192 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10193 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010195payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10196 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10197 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10198 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200req.len : integer
10201req_len : integer (deprecated)
10202 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10203 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10204 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10205 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10206 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10207 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10208 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10209 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10212 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010213 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10214 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10215 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10216 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218 ACL alternatives :
10219 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10222 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10223 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10224 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10225 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 ACL alternatives :
10228 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010232req.proto_http : boolean
10233req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10234 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10235 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10236 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10237 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10238 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10239 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10240 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242 Example:
10243 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10244 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10245 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010246 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010248req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10249rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10250 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10251 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10252 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10253 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10254 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10255 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10256 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10259 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10260 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10261 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10262 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10263 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265 ACL derivatives :
10266 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010268 Example :
10269 listen tse-farm
10270 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10271 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10272 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10273 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10274 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10275 persist rdp-cookie
10276 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10277 # This is only useful makes sense if
10278 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10279 stick-table type string size 204800
10280 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10281 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10282 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010284 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10285 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010287req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10288rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10289 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10290 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10291 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10292 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010294 ACL derivatives :
10295 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010297req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10298req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10299 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10300 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10301 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10302 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10303 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10304 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10305 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010307req.ssl_sni : string
10308req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10309 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10310 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10311 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10312 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10313 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10314 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10315 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10316 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10317 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10318 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10319 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10320 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010322 ACL derivatives :
10323 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325 Examples :
10326 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10327 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10328 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10329 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10330 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010332res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10333rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10334 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10335 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10336 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10337 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10338 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10339 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10340 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342req.ssl_ver : integer
10343req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10344 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10345 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10346 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10347 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10348 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10349 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10350 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10351 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10352 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010354 ACL derivatives :
10355 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010356
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010357res.len : integer
10358 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10359 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10360 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10361 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10362 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10363 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10364 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10365 content inspection.
10366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010367res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10368 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010369 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10370 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10371 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10372 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010374res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10375 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10376 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10377 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10378 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010380 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010382wait_end : boolean
10383 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10384 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10385 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10386 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10387 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10388 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10389 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10390 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392 Examples :
10393 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10394 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10395 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010397 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10398 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10399 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10400 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10401 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10402 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10403 tcp-request content reject
10404
10405
104067.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10407--------------------------------------
10408
10409It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10410This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10411data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10412its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10413HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10414content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10415to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10416more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10417response are indexed.
10418
10419base : string
10420 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10421 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10422 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10423 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10424 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10425 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10426 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10427 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10428
10429 ACL derivatives :
10430 base : exact string match
10431 base_beg : prefix match
10432 base_dir : subdir match
10433 base_dom : domain match
10434 base_end : suffix match
10435 base_len : length match
10436 base_reg : regex match
10437 base_sub : substring match
10438
10439base32 : integer
10440 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10441 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10442 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10443 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10444
10445base32+src : binary
10446 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10447 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10448 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10449 per-URL counters.
10450
10451req.cook([<name>]) : string
10452cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10453 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10454 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10455 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10456 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10457 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10458 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10459 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10460 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10461
10462 ACL derivatives :
10463 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10464 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10465 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10466 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10467 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10468 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10469 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10470 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010472req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10473cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10474 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10475 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10478cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10479 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10480 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10481 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10482 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010484cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10485 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10486 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10487 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10488 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10489 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10490 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10491 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10492 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10493 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10494 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010495
William Lallemanda43ba4e2014-01-28 18:14:25 +010010496capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10497 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10498 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10499 See also: "capture request header"
10500
10501capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10502 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10503 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10504 See also: "capture response header"
10505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010506hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10507 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10508 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10509 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10510 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10511 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10515 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10516 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10517 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10518 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10519 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10520 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10521 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10524 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10525 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10526 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10527 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10530 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10531 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10532 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10533 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10534 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10535 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10536 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10537 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10538 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10539 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10540 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542 ACL derivatives :
10543 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10544 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10545 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10546 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10547 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10548 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10549 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10550 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10551
10552req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10553hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10554 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10555 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10556 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10557 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10558 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10559 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10560 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10561 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10562 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10563
10564req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10565hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10566 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10567 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10568 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10569 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10570 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10571 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10572 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10573 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10574
10575req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10576hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10577 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10578 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10579 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10580 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10581 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10582 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10583 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10584
10585http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10586 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10587 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10588 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10589 basic auth is supported.
10590
10591http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10592 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10593 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10594 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10595 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10596 basic auth is supported.
10597
10598 ACL derivatives :
10599 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10600
10601http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010602 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10603 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10605 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607method : integer + string
10608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10609 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10610 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10611 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10612 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10613 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10614 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616 ACL derivatives :
10617 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619 Example :
10620 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10621 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10622 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010624path : string
10625 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10626 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10627 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10628 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10629 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10630 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10631 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633 ACL derivatives :
10634 path : exact string match
10635 path_beg : prefix match
10636 path_dir : subdir match
10637 path_dom : domain match
10638 path_end : suffix match
10639 path_len : length match
10640 path_reg : regex match
10641 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010643req.ver : string
10644req_ver : string (deprecated)
10645 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10646 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10647 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010649 ACL derivatives :
10650 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010652res.comp : boolean
10653 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10654 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10655 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657res.comp_algo : string
10658 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10659 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10660 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010662res.cook([<name>]) : string
10663scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10664 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10665 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10666 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668 ACL derivatives :
10669 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10672scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10673 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10674 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10675 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010677res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10678scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10679 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10680 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10681 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10684 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10685 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10686 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10687 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10688 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10689 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10690 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10691 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10692 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10695 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10696 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10697 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10698 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10699 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10702shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10703 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10704 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10705 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10706 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10707 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10708 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10709 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10710 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712 ACL derivatives :
10713 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10714 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10715 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10716 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10717 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10718 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10719 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10720 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10721
10722res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10723shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10725 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10726 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10727 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10728 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10731shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10732 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10733 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10734 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10735 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10736 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10737 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10740shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10741 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10742 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10743 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10744 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10745 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10746 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748res.ver : string
10749resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10750 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10751 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753 ACL derivatives :
10754 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10757 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10758 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10759 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10760 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10763 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010765 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767status : integer
10768 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10769 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10770 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010772url : string
10773 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10774 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10775 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10776 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10777 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10778 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10779 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010781 ACL derivatives :
10782 url : exact string match
10783 url_beg : prefix match
10784 url_dir : subdir match
10785 url_dom : domain match
10786 url_end : suffix match
10787 url_len : length match
10788 url_reg : regex match
10789 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010791url_ip : ip
10792 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10793 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10794 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10795 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10796 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10797 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10798 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800url_port : integer
10801 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10802 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10803 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10804 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10807url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10808 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10809 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10810 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10811 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10812 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10813 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10814 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10815 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10816 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818 ACL derivatives :
10819 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10820 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10821 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10822 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10823 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10824 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10825 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10826 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010827
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010829 Example :
10830 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10831 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10832 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10833 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10836 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10837 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10838 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010839
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108417.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010842---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010844Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10845every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010846order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010848ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10849---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010850FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010851HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010852HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10853HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010854HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10855HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10856HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10857HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10858LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010859METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10860METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10861METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10862METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10863METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10864METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010865RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010866REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010867TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010868WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10869---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010870
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108728. Logging
10873----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010875One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10876provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10877very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10878provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10879state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010880to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010881headers.
10882
10883In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10884about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10885send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10886
10887 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10888 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10889 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10890 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10891 at the termination.
10892
10893The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10894allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10895as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10896while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10897real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10898delay.
10899
10900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109018.1. Log levels
10902---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010903
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010904TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010905source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010906HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10907in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10908track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10909syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10910about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010911
10912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109138.2. Log formats
10914----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010915
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010916HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010917and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10918slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10919options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010920
10921 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10922 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10923 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10924 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10925 extents.
10926
10927 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10928 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10929 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10930 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10931 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10932
10933 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10934 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10935 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10936 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10937 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10938
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010939 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10940 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10941 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10942 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10943
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010944 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10945
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010946Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10947specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10948field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10949servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10950always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10951identifier.
10952
10953Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10954 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10955 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10956 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10957 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10958
10959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109608.2.1. Default log format
10961-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010962
10963This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10964as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10965format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10966
10967 Example :
10968 listen www
10969 mode http
10970 log global
10971 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10972
10973 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10974 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10975 (www/HTTP)
10976
10977 Field Format Extract from the example above
10978 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10979 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10980 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10981 4 'to' to
10982 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10983 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10984
10985Detailed fields description :
10986 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10987 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10988 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10989 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10990 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10991 and processed the connection.
10992 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10993
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010994In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10995"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10996connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10997
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010998It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10999will eventually disappear.
11000
11001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110028.2.2. TCP log format
11003---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011004
11005The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11006is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11007information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11008counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11009emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11010environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11011the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11012sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011013specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11014not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11015fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11016marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011017
11018 Example :
11019 frontend fnt
11020 mode tcp
11021 option tcplog
11022 log global
11023 default_backend bck
11024
11025 backend bck
11026 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11027
11028 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11029 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11030 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11031
11032 Field Format Extract from the example above
11033 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11034 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11035 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11036 4 frontend_name fnt
11037 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11038 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11039 7 bytes_read* 212
11040 8 termination_state --
11041 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11042 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11043
11044Detailed fields description :
11045 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011046 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11047 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11048 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11049 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11050 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011051
11052 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011053 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11054 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11055 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011056
11057 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11058 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11059 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11060 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11061
11062 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11063 and processed the connection.
11064
11065 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11066 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11067 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11068 applications.
11069
11070 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11071 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11072 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11073 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11074 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11075
11076 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11077 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11078 See "Timers" below for more details.
11079
11080 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11081 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11082 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11083 "Timers" below for more details.
11084
11085 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11086 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11087 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11088 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11089 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11090 details.
11091
11092 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11093 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11094 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11095 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11096 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11097
11098 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11099 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11100 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11101 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11102 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11103 for more details.
11104
11105 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011106 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011107 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11108 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11109 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011110 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011111
11112 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11113 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11114 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11115 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11116 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11117 caused by a denial of service attack.
11118
11119 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11120 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11121 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11122 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11123 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11124 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11125 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11126 denial of service attack.
11127
11128 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11129 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11130 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11131 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11132 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11133 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11134 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11135 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11136 be processed than on other servers.
11137
11138 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11139 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11140 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11141 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11142 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11143 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11144 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11145 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11146 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11147 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11148 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11149 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11150 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11151
11152 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11153 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11154 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11155 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11156 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11157 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11158 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11159 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11160
11161 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11162 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11163 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11164 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11165 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11166 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11167 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11168 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11169 occurs.
11170
11171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111728.2.3. HTTP log format
11173----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011174
11175The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11176is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11177the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11178are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11179emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11180generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11181"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11182which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011183frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11184is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011185
11186Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11187slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11188with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11189
11190 Example :
11191 frontend http-in
11192 mode http
11193 option httplog
11194 log global
11195 default_backend bck
11196
11197 backend static
11198 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11199
11200 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11201 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11202 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011203 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011204
11205 Field Format Extract from the example above
11206 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11207 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11208 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11209 4 frontend_name http-in
11210 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11211 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11212 7 status_code 200
11213 8 bytes_read* 2750
11214 9 captured_request_cookie -
11215 10 captured_response_cookie -
11216 11 termination_state ----
11217 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11218 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11219 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11220 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11221 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011223
11224Detailed fields description :
11225 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011226 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11227 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11228 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11229 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11230 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011231
11232 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011233 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11234 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11235 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011236
11237 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11238 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11239 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11240 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11241 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11242
11243 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11244 and processed the connection.
11245
11246 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11247 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11248 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11249
11250 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11251 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11252 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11253 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11254 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11255 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11256
11257 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11258 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11259 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11260 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11261 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11262 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11263
11264 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11265 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11266 See "Timers" below for more details.
11267
11268 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11269 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11270 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11271 below for more details.
11272
11273 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11274 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11275 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11276 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11277 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11278 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11279 for more details.
11280
11281 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11282 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11283 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11284 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11285 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11286 details.
11287
11288 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11289 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11290 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11291
11292 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11293 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11294 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11295 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11296 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11297 overflowing.
11298
11299 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11300 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11301 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11302 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11303 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11304 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11305 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11306 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11307
11308 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11309 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11310 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11311 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11312 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11313 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11314 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11315 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11316
11317 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11318 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11319 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11320 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11321 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11322 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11323 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11324
11325 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011326 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011327 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11328 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11329 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011330 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011331 system.
11332
11333 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11334 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11335 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11336 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11337 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11338 caused by a denial of service attack.
11339
11340 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11341 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11342 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11343 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11344 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11345 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11346 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11347 denial of service attack.
11348
11349 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11350 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11351 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11352 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11353 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11354 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11355 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11356 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11357 processed than on other servers.
11358
11359 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11360 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11361 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11362 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11363 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11364 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11365 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11366 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11367 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11368 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11369 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11370 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11371 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11372
11373 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11374 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11375 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11376 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11377 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11378 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11379 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11380 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11381
11382 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11383 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11384 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11385 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11386 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11387 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11388 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11389 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11390 occurs.
11391
11392 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11393 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11394 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11395 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11396 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11397 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11398 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11399 cookies" below for more details.
11400
11401 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11402 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11403 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11404 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11405 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11406 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11407 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11408 and cookies" below for more details.
11409
11410 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11411 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11412 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11413 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11414 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11415 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11416 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11417 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11418
11419
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200114208.2.4. Custom log format
11421------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011422
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011423The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011424mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011425
11426HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11427Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11428separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11429prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11430
11431Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11432variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11433string formats ("Q").
11434
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011435If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011437less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11438the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011440Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011441In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11442in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011443
11444Flags are :
11445 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011446 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011447
11448 Example:
11449
11450 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11451 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11452
11453At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11454
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011455 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11456 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011457
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011458the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011459
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011460 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011461 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011462 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011463
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011464and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11465
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011466 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011467 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11468
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011469Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11470
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011471 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011472 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011473 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11474 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11475 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011476 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11477 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11478 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011479 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011480 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011481 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011482 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011483 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011484 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011485 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11486 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011487 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011488 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11489 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011490 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011491 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11492 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011493 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11494 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11495 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011496 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011497 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11498 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011499 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011500 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11501 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11502 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011503 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011504 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11505 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11506 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11507 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011508 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011509 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011510 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011511 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011512 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011513 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011514 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11515 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11516 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011517 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011518 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11519 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011520 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011521 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011522 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011523 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011524
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011525 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011526
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011527
115288.2.5. Error log format
11529-----------------------
11530
11531When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11532protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11533By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11534"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11535will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11536logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11537
11538The format looks like this :
11539
11540 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11541 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11542 Connection error during SSL handshake
11543
11544 Field Format Extract from the example above
11545 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11546 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11547 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11548 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11549 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11550
11551These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11552failures.
11553
11554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115558.3. Advanced logging options
11556-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011557
11558Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11559just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11560options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11561for more information about their usage.
11562
11563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115648.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11565------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011566
11567It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11568haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11569commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11570monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11571ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11572
11573 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11574 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11575 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11576 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11577
11578 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11579 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11580 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11581 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11582 such as other load-balancers.
11583
11584 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11585 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11586 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11587
11588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11590----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011591
11592The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11593what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11594or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11595"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11596just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11597log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11598after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11599is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11600with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11601with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11602
11603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11605------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011606
11607Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11608for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11609"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11610retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11611raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11612a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11613file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11614you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11615"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11616
11617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116188.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11619--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011620
11621Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11622multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11623them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11624"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11625logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11626error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11627and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11628too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11629useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11630alternative.
11631
11632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116338.4. Timing events
11634------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011635
11636Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11637reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11638the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11639frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11640mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11641
11642 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11643 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11644 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11645 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11646 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11647
11648 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11649 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11650 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11651 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11652 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11653
11654 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11655 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11656 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11657 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11658 connection never established.
11659
11660 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11661 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11662 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11663 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11664 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11665 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11666 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11667 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11668 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11669 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11670 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11671
11672 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11673 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11674 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11675 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11676 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11677
11678 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11679
11680 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11681 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11682 negative.
11683
11684These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11685protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11686that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011687due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011688close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11689session has been aborted on timeout.
11690
11691Most common cases :
11692
11693 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11694 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11695 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11696 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11697 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11698 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11699 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11700 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11701 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011702 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11703 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11704 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011705
11706 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11707 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11708 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11709 of ms on remote networks.
11710
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011711 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11712 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11713 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011714
11715 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11716 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11717 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11718 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11719 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11720 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11721 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11722 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11723 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11724 to the server until another one is released.
11725
11726Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11727
11728 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11729 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11730 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11731
11732 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11733 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11734 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11735
11736 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11737 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11738 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11739 flags.
11740
11741 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11742 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11743 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11744 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11745 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11746 the client connection was maintained open.
11747
11748 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11749 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11750 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11751 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11752
11753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117548.5. Session state at disconnection
11755-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011756
11757TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11758"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
117592-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11760each of which has a special meaning :
11761
11762 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11763 session to terminate :
11764
11765 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11766
11767 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11768 server explicitly refused it.
11769
11770 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11771 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11772 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11773 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011774 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11775
11776 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11777 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011778
11779 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11780 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11781 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11782 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11783 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11784
11785 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11786 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11787 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11788 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11789 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11790
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011791 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11792 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11793
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011794 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11795 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11796 backup connections when going up.
11797
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011798 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011800 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11801 send or receive data.
11802
11803 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11804 send or receive data.
11805
11806 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11807 with nothing left in the buffers.
11808
11809 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11810
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011811 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011812 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11813
11814 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11815 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11816 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11817 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11818 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11819
11820 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11821 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11822
11823 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11824 server (HTTP only).
11825
11826 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11827
11828 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11829 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11830 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11831
11832 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11833 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11834 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11835
11836 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11837
11838 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11839 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11840
11841 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11842 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11843 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11844
11845 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11846 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011847 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11848 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011849
11850 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11851 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11852 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11853 another server.
11854
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011855 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011856 server.
11857
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011858 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11859 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11860 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11861 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11862
11863 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11864 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11865 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11866 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11867
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011868 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11869 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11870 "use-server" rule).
11871
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11873
11874 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11875 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11876
11877 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11878
11879 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11880 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11881 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11882
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011883 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11884 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11885 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11886 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11887 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11888
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011889 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11890
11891 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11892 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11893
11894 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11895
11896 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11897
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011898The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11899was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011900helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11901starvation, attacks, etc...
11902
11903The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11904alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11905easier finding and understanding.
11906
11907 Flags Reason
11908
11909 -- Normal termination.
11910
11911 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11912 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11913 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11914 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11915
11916 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11917 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11918 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11919 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11920 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11921 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011923 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11924 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011925 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011926
11927 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11928 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11929 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11930
11931 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11932 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11933 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11934 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11935 the server takes too long to respond.
11936
11937 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11938 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11939 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11940 long a time to respond.
11941
11942 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11943 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11944 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11945 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11946 and the client.
11947
11948 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11949 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11950 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11951 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11952 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11953 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11954
11955 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11956 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011957 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11958 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11959 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11960 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011961
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011962 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11963 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011965 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011966 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11967 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11968 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11969 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11970 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11971
11972 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11973 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11974 503 or 504 here.
11975
11976 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11977 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11978 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11979 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11980 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11981
11982 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11983 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011984 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011985 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11986 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11987
11988 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11989 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11990 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11991 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11992 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11993 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11994 between haproxy and the server.
11995
11996 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11997 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11998 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11999 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12000 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12001 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12002 solution is to fix the application.
12003
12004 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12005 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12006 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12007 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12008 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12009 external attacks.
12010
12011 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12012 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012013 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012014 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12015 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12016
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012017 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12018 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12019 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012020 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12021 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012022
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012023 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12024 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12025 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12026 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012027 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12028 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12029 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12030 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12031 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012032
12033 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12034 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12035 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12036 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12037
12038 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12039 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12040 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12041 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12042
12043 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12044 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12045 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12046 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12047
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012048The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12049persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12050important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12051re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12052
12053 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12054
12055 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12056 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12057 set on a GET request.
12058
12059 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12060 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012061 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012062 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12063
12064 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12065 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12066 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12067
12068 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12069 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12070 already got a cookie.
12071
12072 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12073 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12074 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12075 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12076 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12077
12078 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12079 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12080 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12081
12082 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12083 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12084 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12085
12086 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12087 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12088
12089 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12090 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12091 then advertised in the response.
12092
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120948.6. Non-printable characters
12095-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012096
12097In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12098consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12099converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12100prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12101being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12102escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12103is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12104'}' when logging headers.
12105
12106Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12107issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12108containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12109
12110Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12111the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12112performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12113
12114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121158.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12116---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012117
12118Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12119achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012120section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012121cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12122the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12123the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012124locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012125not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12126user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12127a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12128wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12129
12130 Examples :
12131 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12132 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12133
12134 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12135 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12136
12137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121388.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12139---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012140
12141Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12142proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12143the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12144server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12145
12146Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12147response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012148section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012149
12150It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012151time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12152appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12154and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12155follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12156request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12157in the logs.
12158
12159 Example :
12160 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12161 listen proxy-out
12162 mode http
12163 option httplog
12164 option logasap
12165 log global
12166 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12167
12168 # log the name of the virtual server
12169 capture request header Host len 20
12170
12171 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12172 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12173
12174 # log the beginning of the referrer
12175 capture request header Referer len 20
12176
12177 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12178 capture response header Server len 20
12179
12180 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12181 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12182
12183 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12184 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12185
12186 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12187 capture response header Via len 20
12188
12189 # log the URL location during a redirection
12190 capture response header Location len 20
12191
12192 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12193 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12194 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12195 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12196 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12197
12198 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12199 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12200 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12201 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012202 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012203
12204 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12205 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12206 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12207 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12208 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012209 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012210
12211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122128.9. Examples of logs
12213---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012214
12215These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12216them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12217reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12218
12219 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12220 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12221 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12222
12223 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12224 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12225
12226 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12227 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12228 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12229
12230 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12231 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12232
12233 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12234 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12235 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12236
12237 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012238 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012239 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12240 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12241
12242 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12243 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12244 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12245
12246 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12247 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012248 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012249 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12250 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12251 to return the 502 and not the server.
12252
12253 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012254 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012255
12256 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12257 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12258 Nothing was sent to any server.
12259
12260 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12261 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12262
12263 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12264 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12265 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12266 send a 408 return code to the client.
12267
12268 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12269 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12270
12271 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12272 5 seconds ("c----").
12273
12274 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12275 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012276 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012277
12278 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012279 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012280 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12281 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12282 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12283 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12284 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012285
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122879. Statistics and monitoring
12288----------------------------
12289
12290It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12291mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12292CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12293Unix socket.
12294
12295
122969.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012297---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012298
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012299The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12300page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012302 0. pxname: proxy name
12303 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12304 for server)
12305 2. qcur: current queued requests
12306 3. qmax: max queued requests
12307 4. scur: current sessions
12308 5. smax: max sessions
12309 6. slim: sessions limit
12310 7. stot: total sessions
12311 8. bin: bytes in
12312 9. bout: bytes out
12313 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012314 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012315 12. ereq: request errors
12316 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012317 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012318 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12319 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012320 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012321 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12322 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12323 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12324 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12325 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12326 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12327 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12328 25. qlimit: queue limit
12329 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12330 27. iid: unique proxy id
12331 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12332 29. throttle: warm up status
12333 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12334 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012335 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012336 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12337 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12338 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012339 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012340 UNK -> unknown
12341 INI -> initializing
12342 SOCKERR -> socket error
12343 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12344 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12345 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12346 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12347 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12348 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12349 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12350 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12351 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12352 disable-on-404
12353 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12354 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12355 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012356 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12357 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012358 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12359 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12360 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12361 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12362 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12363 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012364 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12365 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12366 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12367 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012368 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12369 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012370 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12371 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12372 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012373 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012374
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123769.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012377-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012378
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012379The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12380necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12381A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12382issuing commands by hand :
12383
12384 global
12385 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12386 stats timeout 2m
12387
12388It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12389the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12390never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12391situations :
12392
12393 global
12394 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12395 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12396 stats timeout 2m
12397
12398To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12399swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12400to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12401syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12402
12403 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12404 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12405
12406The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12407script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12408for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12409
12410The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12411that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12412editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12413(eg: watch a counter).
12414
12415The socket supports two operation modes :
12416 - interactive
12417 - non-interactive
12418
12419The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12420this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12421sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12422mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12423commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12424example :
12425
12426 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12427
12428The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12429entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12430for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12431sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12432"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12433after processing the last command of the same line.
12434
12435For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12436"prompt" command :
12437
12438 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12439 prompt
12440 > show info
12441 ...
12442 >
12443
12444Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12445delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12446that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12447parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012448
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012449It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12450on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12451own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012452
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012453The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12454If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12455all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12456it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12457
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012458add map <map> <key> <value>
12459 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12460 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12461 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012463clear counters
12464 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12465 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12466 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12467 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12468 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12469
12470clear counters all
12471 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12472 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12473 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12474
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012475clear map <map>
12476 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12477
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012478clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12479 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12480
12481 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12482 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12483 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12484 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12485 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12486 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12487
12488 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12489
12490 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12491 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12492 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12493 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12494 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12495 the ACLs :
12496
12497 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12498 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12499 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12500 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12501 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12502 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12503
12504 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012505 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12506 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012507
12508 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012509 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012510 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012511 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12512 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12513 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12514 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012515
12516 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12517
12518 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012519 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012520 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12521 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012522 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12523 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12524 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012525
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012526enable agent <backend>/<server>
12527 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12528
12529 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12530 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12531 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12532 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12533 re-enabled using enable agent.
12534
12535 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12536 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12537 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12538 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12539 otherwise unchanged.
12540
12541 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12542 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12543 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12544
12545 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12546 level "admin".
12547
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012548del map <map> <key>
12549 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12550
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012551disable frontend <frontend>
12552 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12553 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12554 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12555 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12556 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12557 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12558 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12559 on the stats page.
12560
12561 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12562 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12563
12564 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12565 level "admin".
12566
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012567disable server <backend>/<server>
12568 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12569 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12570 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12571 during the maintenance.
12572
12573 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12574 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12575
12576 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012577 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012578
12579 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12580 level "admin".
12581
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012582enable agent <backend>/<server>
12583 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12584
12585 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12586 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12587
12588 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12589 level "admin".
12590
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012591enable frontend <frontend>
12592 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12593 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12594 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12595 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12596 which was disabled.
12597
12598 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12599 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12600
12601 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12602 level "admin".
12603
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012604enable server <backend>/<server>
12605 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12606 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12607
12608 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012609 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012610
12611 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12612 level "admin".
12613
12614get weight <backend>/<server>
12615 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12616 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12617 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12618 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12619 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012620 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012621
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012622help
12623 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12624 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012625
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012626prompt
12627 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12628 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12629 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12630 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12631 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12632 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12633 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12634 command.
12635
12636quit
12637 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012638
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012639set map <map> <key> <value>
12640 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12641 is <value>.
12642
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012643set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012644 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12645 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12646 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12647 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12648 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012649 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12650 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12651
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012652set maxconn global <maxconn>
12653 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12654 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12655 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12656 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12657 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12658 setting.
12659
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012660set rate-limit connections global <value>
12661 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12662 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12663 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12664 is passed in number of connections per second.
12665
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012666set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12667 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12668 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012669 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12670 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012671
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012672set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12673 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12674 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12675 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12676 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12677
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012678set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12679 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12680 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12681 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12682 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12683 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12684
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012685set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012686 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12687 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12688 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12689 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012690 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12691 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012692
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012693set timeout cli <delay>
12694 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12695 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12696 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12697
12698set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12699 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12700 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012701 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12702 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12703 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12704 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12705 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12706 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12707 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12708 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12709 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12710 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12711 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12712 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12713 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012714
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012715show errors [<iid>]
12716 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12717 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012718 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12719 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12720 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012721
12722 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12723 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12724 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12725 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12726 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12727 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12728 are reported too.
12729
12730 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12731 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12732 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12733 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12734 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12735 code.
12736
12737 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12738 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12739 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12740 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12741 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12742 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12743 line.
12744
12745 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012746 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12747 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012748 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12749 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12750
12751 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12752 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12753 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12754 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12755 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12756 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12757 00204+ minal\r\n
12758 00211 \r\n
12759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012760 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012761 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12762 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12763 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12764 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12765 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12766 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012767
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012768show info
12769 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12770
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012771show map [<map>]
12772 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12773 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12774
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010012775show pools
12776 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
12777 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
12778 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
12779 the pools.
12780
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012781show sess
12782 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012783 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12784 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12785
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012786show sess <id>
12787 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12788 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12789 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12790 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12791 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012792 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12793 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12794 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012795
12796show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12797 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12798 possible to dump only selected items :
12799 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12800 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12801 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12802 for example:
12803 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12804 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12805 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12806
12807 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012808 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12809 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012810 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12811 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12812 Nbproc: 1
12813 Process_num: 1
12814 (...)
12815
12816 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12817 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12818 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12819 (...)
12820 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12821
12822 $
12823
12824 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12825 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12826 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12827 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012828 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012829
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012830show table
12831 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12832 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12833 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12834 entries currently in use.
12835
12836 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012837 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012838 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12839 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012840
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012841show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012842 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12843 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12844 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012845 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12846
12847 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12848 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12849 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12850 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12851 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12852
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012853 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12854 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12855 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12856 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12857 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12858 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12859
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012860
12861 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012862 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12863 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012864
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012865 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012866 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012867 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012868 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12869 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12870 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12871 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012872
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012873 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012874 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012875 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12876 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012877
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012878 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12879 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012880 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012881 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12882 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012883
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012884 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12885 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012886 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012887 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12888 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12889
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012890 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12891 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12892 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12893 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12894 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12895
12896 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12897 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12898 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012899 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12900 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012901 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12902 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012903
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012904shutdown frontend <frontend>
12905 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12906 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12907 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12908 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12909 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12910 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12911 once it is terminated.
12912
12913 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12914 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12915
12916 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12917 level "admin".
12918
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012919shutdown session <id>
12920 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12921 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12922 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12923 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12924 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12925 flag in the logs.
12926
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012927shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12928 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12929 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12930 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12931 'K' flag in the logs.
12932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012933/*
12934 * Local variables:
12935 * fill-column: 79
12936 * End:
12937 */